blob: aa6baabb4a73f698f697a51e22004524aab1a959 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
778 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200780maxconnrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100790maxcomprate <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300792 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100793 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
794 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
795 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
796 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
797 default value.
798
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100799maxcompcpuusage <number>
800 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
801 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
802 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
803 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
804 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
805 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
806 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
807 process down and from introducing high latencies.
808
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100809maxpipes <number>
810 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
811 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
812 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
813 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
814 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
815 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
816
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200817maxsessrate <number>
818 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
819 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
820 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
821 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
822 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
823 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
824 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
825 fairness.
826
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200827maxsslconn <number>
828 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
829 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
830 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
831 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
832 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
833 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
834 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
835
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200836maxsslrate <number>
837 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
838 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
839 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
840 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
841 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
842 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
843 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
844 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
845 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
846 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
847
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100848maxzlibmem <number>
849 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
850 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
851 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100852 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
853 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
854 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856noepoll
857 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
858 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100859 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
861nokqueue
862 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
863 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
864 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
865
866nopoll
867 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
868 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100869 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100872nosplice
873 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
874 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
875 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100876 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100877 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
878 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
879 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
880 "option splice-response".
881
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300882nogetaddrinfo
883 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
884 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
885
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200886spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900887 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
888 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
889 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
890 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
891 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
892 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200893
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200894tune.bufsize <number>
895 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
896 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
897 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
898 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
899 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
900 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
901 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
902 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400903 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
904 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
905 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200906
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200907tune.chksize <number>
908 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
909 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
910 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
911 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
912 checks whenever possible.
913
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100914tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
915 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
916 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
917 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
918 this value. The default value is 1.
919
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100920tune.http.cookielen <number>
921 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
922 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
923 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
924 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
925 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
926 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
927 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
928 to change this value.
929
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200930tune.http.maxhdr <number>
931 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
932 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
933 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
934 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
935 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
936 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
937 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
938 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
939 limit too high.
940
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100941tune.idletimer <timeout>
942 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
943 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
944 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
945 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
946 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
947 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
948 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
949 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
950 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
951
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100952tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100953 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
954 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
955 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
956 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
957 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
958 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
959 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
960 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
961 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
962 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100963
964tune.maxpollevents <number>
965 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
966 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
967 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
968 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
969 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
970
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200971tune.maxrewrite <number>
972 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
973 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
974 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
975 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
976 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
977 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
978 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
979 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
980 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
981 bufsize.
982
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200983tune.pipesize <number>
984 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
985 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
986 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
987 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
988 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
989 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
990
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100991tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
992tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
993 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
994 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
995 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
996 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
997 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
998 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
999 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1000
1001tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1002tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1003 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1004 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1005 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1006 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1007 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1008 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1009 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1010 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1011 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1012 notifying haproxy again.
1013
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001014tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001015 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1016 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1017 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001018 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001019 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1020 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1021 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1022 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1023 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001024 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1025 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001026
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001027tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1028 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1029 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1030 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1031 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1032 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1033 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1034
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001035tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1036 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001037 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001038 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1039 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1040 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1041 being used for too long.
1042
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001043tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1044 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1045 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1046 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1047 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1048 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1049 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1050 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1051 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1052 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1053 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001054 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1055 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001056
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001057tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1058 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1059 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1060 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1061 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1062 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1063 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1064 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1065 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1066
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001067tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1068 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001070 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1071 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1072 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1073
1074tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1075 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1076 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1077 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1078 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010803.3. Debugging
1081--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082
1083debug
1084 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1085 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1086 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1087 system startup.
1088
1089quiet
1090 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1091 line argument "-q".
1092
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010943.4. Userlists
1095--------------
1096It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1097http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1098it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1099
1100userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001101 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001102 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1103
1104group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001105 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001106 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1107 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1108
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001109user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1110 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1112 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001113 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1114 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001115 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001116 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
1118
1119 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001120 userlist L1
1121 group G1 users tiger,scott
1122 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001123
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001124 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1125 user scott insecure-password elgato
1126 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001128 userlist L2
1129 group G1
1130 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001132 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1133 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1134 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001135
1136 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001138
11393.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001140----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1142haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1143pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1144identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1145or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1146Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1147known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1148the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1149process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1150during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1151tables.
1152
1153peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001154 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001155 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1156
1157peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1158 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1159 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1160 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1161 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1162 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1163 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1164
1165 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1166 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1167
1168 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1169 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1170 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1171 across all peers.
1172
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001173 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1174 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1175 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1176
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001177 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001178 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001179 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1180 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1181 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001182
1183 backend mybackend
1184 mode tcp
1185 balance roundrobin
1186 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1187 stick on src
1188
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001189 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1190 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001191
1192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001194----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001196Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1197 - defaults <name>
1198 - frontend <name>
1199 - backend <name>
1200 - listen <name>
1201
1202A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1203its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1204section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
1207A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1208connections.
1209
1210A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1211to forward incoming connections.
1212
1213A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1214parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001216All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1217'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1218case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1219
1220Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1221logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1222proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1223However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1224name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1225
1226Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1227and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001228bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1230modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1231arbitrary criteria.
1232
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001233In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1234a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1235the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1236
1237 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1238 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1239 between responses and new requests.
1240
1241 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1242 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1243 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1244 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1245
1246 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1247 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1248 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1249
1250 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1251 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1252 client-facing connection remains open.
1253
1254 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1255 after the end of the response.
1256
1257The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1258frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1259following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1260weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1261
1262 Backend mode
1263
1264 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1269 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1270 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1271 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1279--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001281The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1282limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1283they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1284limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001285marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001286option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001287and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1288with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1289specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1293------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1294acl - X X X
1295appsession - - X X
1296backlog X X X -
1297balance X - X X
1298bind - X X -
1299bind-process X X X X
1300block - X X X
1301capture cookie - X X -
1302capture request header - X X -
1303capture response header - X X -
1304clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001305compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1307cookie X - X X
1308default-server X - X X
1309default_backend X X X -
1310description - X X X
1311disabled X X X X
1312dispatch - - X X
1313enabled X X X X
1314errorfile X X X X
1315errorloc X X X X
1316errorloc302 X X X X
1317-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1318errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001319force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320fullconn X - X X
1321grace X X X X
1322hash-type X - X X
1323http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001324http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001325http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001327http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001328http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001329id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001330ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001331log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001332max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001333maxconn X X X -
1334mode X X X X
1335monitor fail - X X -
1336monitor-net X X X -
1337monitor-uri X X X -
1338option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1339option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1340option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1341option allbackups (*) X - X X
1342option checkcache (*) X - X X
1343option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1344option contstats (*) X X X -
1345option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1346option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1347option forceclose (*) X X X X
1348-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1349option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001350option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001351option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001352option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001353option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001354option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001355option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1356option httpchk X - X X
1357option httpclose (*) X X X X
1358option httplog X X X X
1359option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001360option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001361option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001362option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1364option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1365option logasap (*) X X X -
1366option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001367option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option nolinger (*) X X X X
1369option originalto X X X X
1370option persist (*) X - X X
1371option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001372option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001373option smtpchk X - X X
1374option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1375option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1376option splice-request (*) X X X X
1377option splice-response (*) X X X X
1378option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1379option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1380-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001381option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001382option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1383option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1384option tcpka X X X X
1385option tcplog X X X X
1386option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001387external-check command X - X X
1388external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1390rate-limit sessions X X X -
1391redirect - X X X
1392redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1393redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1394reqadd - X X X
1395reqallow - X X X
1396reqdel - X X X
1397reqdeny - X X X
1398reqiallow - X X X
1399reqidel - X X X
1400reqideny - X X X
1401reqipass - X X X
1402reqirep - X X X
1403reqisetbe - X X X
1404reqitarpit - X X X
1405reqpass - X X X
1406reqrep - X X X
1407-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1408reqsetbe - X X X
1409reqtarpit - X X X
1410retries X - X X
1411rspadd - X X X
1412rspdel - X X X
1413rspdeny - X X X
1414rspidel - X X X
1415rspideny - X X X
1416rspirep - X X X
1417rsprep - X X X
1418server - - X X
1419source X - X X
1420srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001421stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001422stats auth X - X X
1423stats enable X - X X
1424stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001425stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426stats realm X - X X
1427stats refresh X - X X
1428stats scope X - X X
1429stats show-desc X - X X
1430stats show-legends X - X X
1431stats show-node X - X X
1432stats uri X - X X
1433-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1434stick match - - X X
1435stick on - - X X
1436stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001437stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001438stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001439tcp-check connect - - X X
1440tcp-check expect - - X X
1441tcp-check send - - X X
1442tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001443tcp-request connection - X X -
1444tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001445tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001446tcp-response content - - X X
1447tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448timeout check X - X X
1449timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1452timeout connect X - X X
1453timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1454timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1455timeout http-request X X X X
1456timeout queue X - X X
1457timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001458timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1460timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001461timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001463unique-id-format X X X -
1464unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001465use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001466use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001467------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1468 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1472---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1475
1476
1477acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1478 Declare or complete an access list.
1479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1480 no | yes | yes | yes
1481 Example:
1482 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1483 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1484 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001489appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1490 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | no | yes | yes
1494 Arguments :
1495 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1496 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1497
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001498 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001499 checked in each cookie value.
1500
1501 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1502 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1503 milliseconds.
1504
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001505 request-learn
1506 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1507 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1508 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1509 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1510 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1511 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1512
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001513 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1514 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1515 data following this prefix.
1516
1517 Example :
1518 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1519
1520 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1521 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1522
1523 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1524 2 modes are currently supported :
1525 - path-parameters :
1526 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1527 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1528 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1529 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1530 - query-string :
1531 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1532 query string.
1533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1535 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1536 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1537 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001538 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1539 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1540 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1542 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1543
1544 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001546 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1547 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1548 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550 Example :
1551 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001553 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1554 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555
1556
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557backlog <conns>
1558 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1560 yes | yes | yes | no
1561 Arguments :
1562 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1563 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001564 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001565
1566 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1567 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1568 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1569 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1570 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1571 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1572 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1573 backlog parameter.
1574
1575 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1576 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1577 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1578
1579 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1580
1581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001582balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001583balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1586 yes | no | yes | yes
1587 Arguments :
1588 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1589 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1590 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1591 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1592
1593 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1594 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1595 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1596 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001597 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001598 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001599 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1600 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1601 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1602 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1603 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1604 it, so that you don't worry.
1605
1606 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1607 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1608 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1609 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1610 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1611 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1612 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1613 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001615 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1616 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1617 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1618 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1619 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1620 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1621 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1622 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1623
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001624 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001625 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1627 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001628 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001629 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1630 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1631 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1632 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1633 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001634 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1635 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1636 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1637 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1638 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1639 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1642 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1643 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1644 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1645 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1646 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1647 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1648 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001649 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001651 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1652 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1653 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001654
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001655 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1656 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1657 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1658 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1659 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1660 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1661 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1662 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1663 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1664 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1665 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1666 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001667
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001668 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001669 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1670 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1671 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1672 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1673 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1674 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1675 URIs start with a leading "/".
1676
1677 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1678 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1679 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1680 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001683 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1684
1685 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001686 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1687 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001688 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1689 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1690 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1691 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001692 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001693 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1694 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695
1696 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1697 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1698 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1699 server will receive the request.
1700
1701 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1702 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1703 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1704 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1705 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001706 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1707 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1708 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001710 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1711 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1712 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1713 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1714 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001717 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1718 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1719 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1720
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001721 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1722 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1723 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1724
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001725 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001726 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001727 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1728 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1729 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1730 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1731 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1732 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001734 used instead.
1735
1736 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1737 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1738 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1739 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1740
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001741 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1742 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1743 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1744
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001745 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001748 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1749 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001751 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1752 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1753 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
1755 Examples :
1756 balance roundrobin
1757 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001758 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001759 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1760 balance hdr(host)
1761 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001762
1763 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1764 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001767 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1768 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1769 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1770 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1771
1772 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1773 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1774 defaults to 16 kB.
1775
1776 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1777 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1778
1779 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1780 Round Robin.
1781
1782 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1783 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1784 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1785 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1786
1787 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1788
1789 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001790 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001791 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1792 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1793 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001795 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1796 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001799bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1800bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1803 no | yes | yes | no
1804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001805 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1806 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1807 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1808 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001809 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001810 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1811 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1812 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1813 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1814 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1815 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1816 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001817 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1818 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1819 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1820 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1821 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1822 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1823 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001824 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1825 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1826 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001827 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1828 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1829 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1830 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001831
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001832 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1833 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1835 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1836 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001837 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1838 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1839 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1840 the range.
1841
1842 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1843 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1844 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1845 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1846 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1847 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1848 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001849 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001850 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001852 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1853 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1854 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1855 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1856 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1857 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1858 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1859 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001861 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1862 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1863 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1864 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1867 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1868 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1869 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1870 in a frontend.
1871
1872 Example :
1873 listen http_proxy
1874 bind :80,:443
1875 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001878 listen http_https_proxy
1879 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001880 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001881
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001882 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1883 bind ipv6@:80
1884 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1885 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1886
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001887 listen external_bind_app1
1888 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1889
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001890 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001891 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1897 yes | yes | yes | yes
1898 Arguments :
1899 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1900 may be used to override a default value.
1901
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001902 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001903 option may be combined with other numbers.
1904
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001905 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001906 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1907 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1908 missing from all processes.
1909
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001910 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001911 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001912 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1913 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1914 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1915 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001916
1917 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1918 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1919 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1920 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1921 and 'even' instances.
1922
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001923 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1924 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1925 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1926 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001928 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1929 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1930
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001931 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1932 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1933 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1934
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001935 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1936 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1937
1938 Example :
1939 listen app_ip1
1940 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
1943 listen app_ip2
1944 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001945 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001946
1947 listen management
1948 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001949 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001950
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001951 listen management
1952 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1953 bind-process 1-4
1954
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001955 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001956
1957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958block { if | unless } <condition>
1959 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | yes
1962
1963 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1964 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001965 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001966 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1968 "block" statements per instance.
1969
1970 Example:
1971 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1972 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1973 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1974 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001976 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977
1978
1979capture cookie <name> len <length>
1980 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1982 no | yes | yes | no
1983 Arguments :
1984 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1985 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1986 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1987 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1988 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1989
1990 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1991 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1992 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1993 right if it exceeds <length>.
1994
1995 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1996 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1997 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1998 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1999
2000 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2001 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2002 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2003
2004 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2005 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2006 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002007 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2008 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2009 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
2011 Example:
2012 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2013
2014 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002015 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
2017
2018capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002019 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2021 no | yes | yes | no
2022 Arguments :
2023 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002024 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2026 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2027 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2028
2029 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2030 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2031 it exceeds <length>.
2032
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002033 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2035 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002036 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2037 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2038 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2039 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002040 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002041 environments to find where the request came from.
2042
2043 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2044 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2045 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2046 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002048 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2049 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2050 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2051 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2052 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
2054 Example:
2055 capture request header Host len 15
2056 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2057 capture request header Referrer len 15
2058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002059 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 about logging.
2061
2062
2063capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002064 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2066 no | yes | yes | no
2067 Arguments :
2068 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002069 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2071 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2072 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2073
2074 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2075 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2076 it exceeds <length>.
2077
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002078 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2080 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2081 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002082 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2083 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2084 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2085 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002087 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2088 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2089 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2090 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2091 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
2093 Example:
2094 capture response header Content-length len 9
2095 capture response header Location len 15
2096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002097 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098 about logging.
2099
2100
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002101clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | no
2105 Arguments :
2106 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2108 as explained at the top of this document.
2109
2110 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2111 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2112 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2113 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2114 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2115 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2116 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2117 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002118 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2120 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2121
2122 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2123 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2124 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2125 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2126 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2127 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2128
2129 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2130 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2131
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2133 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002135compression algo <algorithm> ...
2136compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002137compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002138 Enable HTTP compression.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002142 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2143 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2144 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2145
2146 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002147 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002148 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2149 data.
2150
2151 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2152 support for zlib was built in.
2153
2154 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2155 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2156 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2157 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2158 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2159 in.
2160
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002161 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002162 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002163 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2164 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2165 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2166 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2167 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002168
2169 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2170 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2171 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2172 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2173 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002174 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2175 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2176 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2177 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2178 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002179 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2180 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002181
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002182 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002183 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2184 "Accept-Encoding" header
2185 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002186 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002187 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2188 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002189 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2190 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2191 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2192 "multipart"
2193 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2194 header
2195 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2196 and later
2197 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2198 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002199
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002200 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2201 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002202
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002203 Examples :
2204 compression algo gzip
2205 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002207contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002208 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | no | yes | yes
2211 Arguments :
2212 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2214 as explained at the top of this document.
2215
2216 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002217 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002218 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2220 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2221 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2222 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2223
2224 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2226 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2227 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2228 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2229 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2230
2231 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2232 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2233 instead.
2234
2235 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2236 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2237
2238
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002239cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002240 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2241 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 yes | no | yes | yes
2245 Arguments :
2246 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2247 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2248 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2249 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2250 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2251 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2252 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2253 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2254 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2255
2256 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2257 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2258 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2259 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2260 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2261 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2262 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2263 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2264 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2265 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2266 "insert" and "prefix".
2267
2268 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002269 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002270
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002271 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002272 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2273 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2274 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2275 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2276 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2277 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2278 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2279 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2280 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2281 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
2283 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2284 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2285 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2286 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2287 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2288 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2289 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2290 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2291 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2292 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002293 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2294 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2295 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002297 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2298 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2299 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002300 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2301 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2302 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2303 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002304 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2305 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2306 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2309 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2310 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2311 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2312 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2313 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2314 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2315 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2316 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2317
2318 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2319 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2320 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2321 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2322 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2323 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2324 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2325 persistence cookie in the cache.
2326 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2327
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002328 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2329 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2330 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2331 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2332 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2333 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2334 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2335 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2336 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2337 they logout.
2338
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002339 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2340 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2341 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2342 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2343
2344 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2345 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2346 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2347 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2348 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2349 this attribute.
2350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002352 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002353 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2354 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2355 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2356 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2357 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2358 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002359
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002360 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2361 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2362 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2363 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2364 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2365 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2366 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2367 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2368 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2369 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2370 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2371 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2372 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2373 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2374 the site.
2375
2376 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2377 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2378 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2379 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2380 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2381 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2382 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2383 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2384 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2385 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2386 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2387 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2388 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2389 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2390 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2391 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2394 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2395 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2396 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398 Examples :
2399 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2400 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2401 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002402 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002404 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002405 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002408default-server [param*]
2409 Change default options for a server in a backend
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2411 yes | no | yes | yes
2412 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002413 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2414 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2415 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2416 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002417
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002418 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002419 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2420
2421 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424default_backend <backend>
2425 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | yes | yes | no
2428 Arguments :
2429 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2430
2431 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2432 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2433 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2434 will catch all undetermined requests.
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436 Example :
2437
2438 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2439 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2440 default_backend dynamic
2441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002442 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002445description <string>
2446 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 no | yes | yes | yes
2449 Arguments : string
2450
2451 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2452 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2453 it describes.
2454 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2455
2456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457disabled
2458 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 yes | yes | yes | yes
2461 Arguments : none
2462
2463 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2464 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2465 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2466 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2467 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2468 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2469 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2470
2471 See also : "enabled"
2472
2473
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002474dispatch <address>:<port>
2475 Set a default server address
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002478 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002479
2480 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2481 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2482 during start-up.
2483
2484 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2485 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2486 possible with normal servers.
2487
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002488 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002489 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2490 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2491 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2492 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2493
2494 See also : "server"
2495
2496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497enabled
2498 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2500 yes | yes | yes | yes
2501 Arguments : none
2502
2503 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2504 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2505
2506 See also : "disabled"
2507
2508
2509errorfile <code> <file>
2510 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | yes
2513 Arguments :
2514 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002515 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002518 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002520 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2521 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
2523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2530 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2531 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2532 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2533
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002534 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2535 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2536 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2537 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2538 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2539 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002541 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2542 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2543 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002544 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2546
2547 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2548
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002549 Example :
2550 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002551 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002552 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2553 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2554
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002555
2556errorloc <code> <url>
2557errorloc302 <code> <url>
2558 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 yes | yes | yes | yes
2561 Arguments :
2562 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002563 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002564
2565 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2566 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2567 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2568 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2569 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2570
2571 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2572 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2573 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2574
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002575 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2578 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2579 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2580 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2581 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2582 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2583 request.
2584
2585 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2586
2587
2588errorloc303 <code> <url>
2589 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 yes | yes | yes | yes
2592 Arguments :
2593 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2594 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2595
2596 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2597 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2598 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2599 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2600 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2601
2602 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2603 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2604 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2605
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002606 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2609 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2610 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2611 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002612 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613
2614 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2615
2616
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002617force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2618 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | yes
2621
2622 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2623 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2624 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2625 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2626 marked down for maintenance operations.
2627
2628 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2629 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2630 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2631 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2632 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2633 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2634 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2635 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2636 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2637
2638 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2639 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2640 is used.
2641
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002642 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002643 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002644
2645
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646fullconn <conns>
2647 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | no | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
2651 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2652 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2653
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002654 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002656 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2658 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2659 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2660 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2661 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002662 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002664 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2665 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002666 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2667 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2668 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002670 Example :
2671 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2672 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2673 # connections.
2674 backend dynamic
2675 fullconn 10000
2676 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2677 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2678
2679 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2680
2681
2682grace <time>
2683 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 Arguments :
2687 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2688 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2689 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2690
2691 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2692 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002693 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2695
2696 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2697 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2698 simplify it.
2699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002701hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2704 yes | no | yes | yes
2705 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002706 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2707 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002708
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002709 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2710 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2711 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2712 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2713 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2714 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2715 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2716 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2717 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2718 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002719
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002720 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2721 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2722 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2723 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2724 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2725 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2726 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2727 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2728 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2729 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2730 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2731 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2732 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002733 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2734 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002735
2736 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2737
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002738 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002739 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2740 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2741 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002742 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2743 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2744 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745
2746 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2747 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002748 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2749 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2750 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2751 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2752
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002753 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2754 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2755 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2756 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2757 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2758 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2759 parameter.
2760
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002761 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2762
2763 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2764 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2765 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2766 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2767 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2768 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2769 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2770 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2771 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2772 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2773 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2774 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002775
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002776 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2777 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2778 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002779
2780 See also : "balance", "server"
2781
2782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783http-check disable-on-404
2784 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002786 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 Arguments : none
2788
2789 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2790 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2791 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2792 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2793 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2794 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2795 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2796 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002797 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2798 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2799 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2800
2801 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2802
2803
2804http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002805 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002808 Arguments :
2809 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2810 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002811 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2813 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2814 details on the supported keywords.
2815
2816 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2817 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2818 with the usual backslash ('\').
2819
2820 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2821 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2822 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2823 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2824 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2825
2826 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002827 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002828 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2829 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2830 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2831
2832 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002834 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2835 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2836 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2837 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2838
2839 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002840 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002841 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2842 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2843 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2844 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2845 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2846 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2847 trace).
2848
2849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002851 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2852 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2853 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2854 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2855 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2856 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2857
2858 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2859 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2860 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2861 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2862 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2863 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2864 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2865 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2866
2867 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2868 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2869
2870 Examples :
2871 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002872 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002873
2874 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002875 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002876
2877 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002878 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879
2880 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002881 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002883 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002884
2885
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002886http-check send-state
2887 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2889 yes | no | yes | yes
2890 Arguments : none
2891
2892 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2893 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2894 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2895 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2896 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2897
2898 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2899 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2900 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2901 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2902 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2903 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2904 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2905 checked in multiple backends.
2906
2907 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2908 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2909
2910 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2911 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2912 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2913 one fails.
2914
2915 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2916 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2917 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2918
2919 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2920 server's queue.
2921
2922 Example of a header received by the application server :
2923 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2924 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2925
2926 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2927
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002928http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002929 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002930 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002931 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2932 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002933 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2934 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2935 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2936 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002937 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2938 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002939 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002941 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2942
2943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2944 no | yes | yes | yes
2945
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002946 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2947 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2948 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2949 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2950 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002952 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2953 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2954 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2955
2956 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2957 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2958 are evaluated.
2959
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002960 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2961 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2962 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2963 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2964 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2965 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2966 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2967 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2968 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002969 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002970 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2971
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002972 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2973 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2974 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2975 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2976 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2977
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002978 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2979 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2980 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002981 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2982 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002983
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002984 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2985 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2986 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2987 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2988 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2989 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2990 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2991 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2992
2993 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2994 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2995 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2996 external users.
2997
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002998 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2999 <name>.
3000
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003001 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3002 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3003 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3004 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3005 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3006 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3007 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3008 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3009
3010 Example:
3011
3012 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3013
3014 applied to:
3015
3016 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3017
3018 outputs:
3019
3020 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3021
3022 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3023
3024 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3025 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3026 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3027 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3028 header.
3029
3030 Example:
3031
3032 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3033
3034 applied to:
3035
3036 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3037
3038 outputs:
3039
3040 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3041
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003042 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3043 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3044 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3045 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3046 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3047 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3048 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3049 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3050
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003051 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3052 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3053 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3054 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3055 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3056 another equipment.
3057
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003058 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3059 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3060 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3061 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3062 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3063 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3064 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3065 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3066
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003067 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3068 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3069 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3070 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3071 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3072 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3073 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3074 admin privileges.
3075
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003076 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3077 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3078 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3079 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3080 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3081 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3082 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3083 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3084
3085 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3086 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3087 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3088 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3089 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3090 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3091
3092 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3093 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3094 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3095 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3096 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3097 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3098
3099 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3100 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3101 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3102 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3103 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3104 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3105 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3106 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3107 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3108
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003109 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3110 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3111 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3112 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3113 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3114 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3115 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3116 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3117 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3118 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3119 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3120 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3121
3122 These actions take one or two arguments :
3123 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3124 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3125 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3126 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3127
3128 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3129 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3130 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3131 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3132
3133 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3134 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3135 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3136 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3137 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3138 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3139 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3140 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3141
3142 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3143 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3144 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3145 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3146 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3147
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003148 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3149
3150 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3151 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3152 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3153 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003154
3155 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003156 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3157 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3158 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003159
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003160 http-request allow if nagios
3161 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3162 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3163 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003164
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003165 Example:
3166 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003167 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003168
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003169 Example:
3170 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3171 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3172 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3173 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3174 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3175 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3176 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3177 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3178 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3179
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003180 Example:
3181 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3182 acl add path /addacl
3183 acl del path /delacl
3184
3185 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3186
3187 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3188 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3189
3190 Example:
3191 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3192 acl setmap path /setmap
3193 acl delmap path /delmap
3194
3195 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3196
3197 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3198 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3199
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003200 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3201 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003202
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003203http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003204 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003205 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3206 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003207 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3208 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3209 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3210 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3211 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3212 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003214 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3215
3216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 no | yes | yes | yes
3218
3219 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3220 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3221 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3222 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3223 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3224 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3225
3226 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3227 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3228 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3229 current section.
3230
3231 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3232 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3233 rules are evaluated.
3234
3235 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3236 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3237 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3238 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3239 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3240 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3241 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3242
3243 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3244 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3245 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3246 external users.
3247
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003248 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3249 <name>.
3250
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003251 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3252 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3253 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3254 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3255 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3256 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3257 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3258 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3259
3260 Example:
3261
3262 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3263
3264 applied to:
3265
3266 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3267
3268 outputs:
3269
3270 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3271
3272 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3273
3274 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3275 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3276 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3277 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3278 header.
3279
3280 Example:
3281
3282 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3283
3284 applied to:
3285
3286 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3287
3288 outputs:
3289
3290 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3291
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003292 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3293 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3294 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3295 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3296 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3297 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3298 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3299 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3300
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003301 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3302 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3303 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3304 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3305 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3306 another equipment.
3307
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003308 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3309 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3310 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3311 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3312 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3313 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3314 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3315 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3316
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003317 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3318 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3319 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3320 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3321 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3322 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3323 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3324 admin privileges.
3325
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003326 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3327 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3328 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3329 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3330 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3331 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3332 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3333 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3334
3335 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3336 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3337 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3338 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3339 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3340 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3341
3342 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3343 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3344 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3345 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3346 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3347 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3348
3349 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3350 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3351 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3352 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3353 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3354 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3355 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3356 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3357 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3358
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003359 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3360
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003361 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003362 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3363 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3364 rules.
3365
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003366 Example:
3367 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3368
3369 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3370
3371 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3372 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3373
3374 Example:
3375 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3376
3377 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3378
3379 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3380 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3381
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003382 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3383 ACL usage.
3384
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003385
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003386http-send-name-header [<header>]
3387 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3388
3389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | no | yes | yes
3391
3392 Arguments :
3393
3394 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3395
3396 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3397 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3398 is added with the header string proved.
3399
3400 See also : "server"
3401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003402id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003403 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3405 no | yes | yes | yes
3406 Arguments : none
3407
3408 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3409 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3410 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003411
3412
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003413ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3414 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3416 no | yes | yes | yes
3417
3418 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3419 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3420 and running).
3421
3422 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3423 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3424 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003425 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003426 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3427
3428 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3429 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3430
3431 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3432 "unless" condition is met.
3433
3434 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3435
3436
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003437log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003438log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003439no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003440 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003443
3444 Prefix :
3445 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3446 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3447 prefix does not allow arguments.
3448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003449 Arguments :
3450 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3451 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3452 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3453 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3454 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3455 parameter.
3456
3457 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3458 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3459
3460 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3461 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3462 standard syslog port).
3463
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003464 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3465 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3466 standard syslog port).
3467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3469 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3470 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3471 appropriately writeable).
3472
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003473 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3474 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3475 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3476 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3477
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003478 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3479 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3480 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3481 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3482 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3483 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3484 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3485 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3486 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3487 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3488 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3491
3492 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3493 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3494 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3495
3496 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3497 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3498 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003499 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3500 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3501 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3502 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3503 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504
3505 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3506
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003507 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3508 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3509 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003510
3511 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3512 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3513 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3514 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3515
3516 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3517 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003518
3519 Example :
3520 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003521 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3522 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003523 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3524
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003525
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003526log-format <string>
3527 Allows you to custom a log line.
3528
3529 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003532max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3533 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | no | yes | yes
3536
3537 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3538 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3539 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3540 servers.
3541
3542 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3543 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3544 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3545 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3546 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3547 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3548 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3549 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3550 picking a different server.
3551
3552 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3553 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3554 even if they have to be queued.
3555
3556 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3557 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3558
3559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560maxconn <conns>
3561 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | yes | yes | no
3564 Arguments :
3565 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3566 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3567 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3568 closes.
3569
3570 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3571 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3572 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3573 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3574 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3575 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3576 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3577 properly tuned.
3578
3579 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3580 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3581 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3582
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003583 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3586
3587
3588mode { tcp|http|health }
3589 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 yes | yes | yes | yes
3592 Arguments :
3593 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3594 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3595 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3596 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3597
3598 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3599 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3600 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3601 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3602 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3603
3604 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003605 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3606 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3607 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3608 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3609 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3610 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3611 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003612
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003613 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3614 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3615 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003617 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003618 defaults http_instances
3619 mode http
3620
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003621 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003624monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 Arguments :
3629 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3630 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003631 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3633 backend and its backup.
3634
3635 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3636 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3637 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3638 servers in a list of backends.
3639
3640 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3641 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3642 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3643 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3644 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3645 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3646 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003647 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3648 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003649
3650 Example:
3651 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003652 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3654 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3655 monitor-uri /site_alive
3656 monitor fail if site_dead
3657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003658 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659
3660
3661monitor-net <source>
3662 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | yes | yes | no
3665 Arguments :
3666 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3667 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3668 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3669 followed by a mask.
3670
3671 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3672 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003673 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003674 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3675
3676 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3677 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3678 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3679 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003680 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3681 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3682 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003683
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003684 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3685 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3686 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3687 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3688 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3689 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003691 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3692 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694 Example :
3695 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3696 frontend www
3697 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3698
3699 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3700
3701
3702monitor-uri <uri>
3703 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | no
3706 Arguments :
3707 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3708 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3709
3710 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3711 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3712 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3713 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3714 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3715 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3716 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3717 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3718
3719 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3720 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3721 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3722 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3723 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3724 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3725
3726 Example :
3727 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3728 frontend www
3729 mode http
3730 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3731
3732 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003735option abortonclose
3736no option abortonclose
3737 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | no | yes | yes
3740 Arguments : none
3741
3742 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3743 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3744 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3745 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003746 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003747 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3748 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3749 encountered while delivering the response.
3750
3751 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3752 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3753 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3754 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3755 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3756 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003757 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003758 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003759 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003760 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3761 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3762 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3763
3764 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3765 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3766 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3767 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3768 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3769 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3770 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3771 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003772 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003773
3774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3776
3777 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3778
3779
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003780option accept-invalid-http-request
3781no option accept-invalid-http-request
3782 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 yes | yes | yes | no
3785 Arguments : none
3786
3787 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3788 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3789 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3790 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3791 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3792 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3793 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3794 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003795 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3796 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3797 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3798 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3799 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3800 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003801
3802 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3803 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3804 been confirmed.
3805
3806 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3807 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003808 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3809 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003810 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
3815 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3816 stats socket.
3817
3818
3819option accept-invalid-http-response
3820no option accept-invalid-http-response
3821 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | no | yes | yes
3824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3827 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3828 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3829 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3830 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3831 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3832 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3833 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3834 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3835
3836 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3837 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3838 been confirmed.
3839
3840 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3841 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3842 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3843 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3844
3845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3847
3848 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3849 stats socket.
3850
3851
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003852option allbackups
3853no option allbackups
3854 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857 Arguments : none
3858
3859 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3860 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3861 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3862 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3863 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3864 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3865 order between the backup servers anymore.
3866
3867 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3868 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3869
3870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3872
3873
3874option checkcache
3875no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003876 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 yes | no | yes | yes
3879 Arguments : none
3880
3881 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3882 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003883 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003884 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3885 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003886 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003887
3888 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003889 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003890 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003891 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3892 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003893 to the client are :
3894 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003895 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003896 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003897 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3898 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3899 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3900 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3901 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3902 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3903 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3904 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3905 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3906 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3907 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3908
3909 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003910 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003911 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003912 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003913 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3914
3915 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3916 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003917 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003918 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3919
3920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3922
3923
3924option clitcpka
3925no option clitcpka
3926 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | no
3929 Arguments : none
3930
3931 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3932 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3933 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3934 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3935
3936 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3937 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3938 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3939 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3940
3941 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3942 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3943 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3944 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3945 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3946
3947 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3948
3949 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3950 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3951 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3952
3953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3955
3956 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3957
3958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959option contstats
3960 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | yes | yes | no
3963 Arguments : none
3964
3965 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3966 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3967 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3968 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3969 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3970 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3971 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3972
3973
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003974option dontlog-normal
3975no option dontlog-normal
3976 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | yes | yes | no
3979 Arguments : none
3980
3981 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3982 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3983 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3984 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3985 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3986 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3987 logged.
3988
3989 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3990 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3991 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003993 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003994 logging.
3995
3996
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997option dontlognull
3998no option dontlognull
3999 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | yes | yes | no
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4005 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4006 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4007 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4008 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4009 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4010 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4011
4012 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4013 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4014 would not be logged.
4015
4016 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4017 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004019 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004020
4021
4022option forceclose
4023no option forceclose
4024 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004026 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004027 Arguments : none
4028
4029 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4030 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4031 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4032 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4033 global session times in the logs.
4034
4035 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004036 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004037 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004038
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004039 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4040 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4041 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4042
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004043 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4044 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004045
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4048
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004049 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004050
4051
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004052option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004053 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | yes | yes | yes
4056 Arguments :
4057 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4058 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004059 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004060 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061
4062 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4063 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4064 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4065 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4066 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4067 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4068 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004069 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4070 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4071 possible that the client has already brought one.
4072
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004073 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004074 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004075 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4076 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004077 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4078 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004079
4080 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4081 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4082 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4083 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4084 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4085 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4086 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4087
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004088 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4089 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4090 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4091 are under the control of the end-user.
4092
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004093 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004094 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4095 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004096 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4097 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4098 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004099
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004100 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004101 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4102 frontend www
4103 mode http
4104 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4105
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004106 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4107 backend www
4108 mode http
4109 option forwardfor header X-Client
4110
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004111 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004112 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004113
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004114
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004115option http-keep-alive
4116no option http-keep-alive
4117 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4119 yes | yes | yes | yes
4120 Arguments : none
4121
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004122 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4123 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4124 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4125 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4126 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4127 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4128 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4129
4130 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4131 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004132 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4133 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4134 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4135 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4136 situations where this option may be useful :
4137
4138 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4139 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4140
4141 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4142 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4143
4144 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4145 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4146 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4147 request.
4148
4149 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4150 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004151 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4152 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4153 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004154
4155 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4156 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4157
4158 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4159 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4160 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4161 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4162 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4163 not set.
4164
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004165 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4166 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004167 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004168 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004169
4170 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004171 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4172 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004173
4174
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004175option http-no-delay
4176no option http-no-delay
4177 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | yes | yes | yes
4180 Arguments : none
4181
4182 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4183 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4184 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4185 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4186 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4187 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4188 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4189 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4190 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4191 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4192 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4193 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4194 affected.
4195
4196 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4197 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4198 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4199 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4200 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4201 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4202 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4203 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4204 latency environments.
4205
4206
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004207option http-pretend-keepalive
4208no option http-pretend-keepalive
4209 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4211 yes | yes | yes | yes
4212 Arguments : none
4213
4214 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4215 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4216 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4217 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4218 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4219 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4220 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4221 consider the response complete.
4222
4223 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4224 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4225 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4226 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4227 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4228 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4229
4230 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4231 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4232 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4233 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4234 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4235 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4236 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4237
4238 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4239 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004240 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004241 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4242 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004243
4244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4246
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004247 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4248 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004249
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004250
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004251option http-server-close
4252no option http-server-close
4253 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | yes | yes | yes
4256 Arguments : none
4257
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004258 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4259 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4260 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4261 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4262 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4263 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4264 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4265 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4266 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4267 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4268 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4269 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4270 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4271 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4272 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4273 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004274
4275 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4276 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4277 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4278 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004279 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4280 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004281
4282 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4283 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004284 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4285 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004286 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4287 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004288
4289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4291
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004292 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004293 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4294 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004295
4296
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004297option http-tunnel
4298no option http-tunnel
4299 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | yes | yes | yes
4302 Arguments : none
4303
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004304 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4305 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4306 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4307 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4308 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4309 "option http-tunnel".
4310
4311 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004312 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004313 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4314 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4315 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4316 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4317 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4318 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4319 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004320
4321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4323
4324 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4325 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4326 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4327
4328
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004329option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004330no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004331 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | no
4334 Arguments : none
4335
4336 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4337 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4338 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4339 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4340 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4341 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4342 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4343
4344 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4345 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4346 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4347 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4348 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4349 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4350 request along its whole life.
4351
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004352 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4353 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4354 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4355 front of an existing proxy.
4356
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004357 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4358
4359 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4360 http-server-close".
4361
4362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004363option httpchk
4364option httpchk <uri>
4365option httpchk <method> <uri>
4366option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4367 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | no | yes | yes
4370 Arguments :
4371 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4372 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4373 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4374 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4375 ones.
4376
4377 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4378 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4379 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4380
4381 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4382 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4383 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4384 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4385 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4386
4387 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4388 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4389 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4390 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4391 the lack of any response.
4392
4393 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4394
4395 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4396 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4397 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4398
4399 Examples :
4400 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4401 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4402 backend https_relay
4403 mode tcp
4404 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4405 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4406
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004407 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4408 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4409 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004410
4411
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004412option httpclose
4413no option httpclose
4414 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 yes | yes | yes | yes
4417 Arguments : none
4418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4420 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4421 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4422 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004423 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004424 "option http-tunnel".
4425
4426 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4427 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4428 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4429 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4430 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4431 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4432 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4433 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004434
4435 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004436 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004437 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4438 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4439 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4440 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4441 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442
4443 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4444 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004445 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4446 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004447 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4448 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004449
4450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4452
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004453 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4454 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004455
4456
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004457option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004458 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004461 Arguments :
4462 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4463 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4464 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4465 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4466 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004467
4468 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4469 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4470 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4471 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4472 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4473 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4474 ports.
4475
4476 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4477
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004478 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4479 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4480 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4481 by default.
4482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004483 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004484
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004485
4486option http_proxy
4487no option http_proxy
4488 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 yes | yes | yes | yes
4491 Arguments : none
4492
4493 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4494 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4495 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4496 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4497 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4498
4499 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4500 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4501 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4502 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004503 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004504 be analyzed.
4505
4506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4508
4509 Example :
4510 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4511 backend direct_forward
4512 option httpclose
4513 option http_proxy
4514
4515 See also : "option httpclose"
4516
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004517
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004518option independent-streams
4519no option independent-streams
4520 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | yes
4523 Arguments : none
4524
4525 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4526 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4527 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4528 receive data or not.
4529
4530 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4531 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4532 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4533 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4534 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4535 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4536 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4537 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4538 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4539 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4540 socket buffers.
4541
4542 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4543 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4544 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4545 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4546 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4547
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004548 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004549 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4550 deprecated.
4551
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004552 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004553
4554
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004555option ldap-check
4556 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 yes | no | yes | yes
4559 Arguments : none
4560
4561 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4562 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4563 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4564 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4565
4566 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4567 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4568
4569 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4570 configure it.
4571
4572 Example :
4573 option ldap-check
4574
4575 See also : "option httpchk"
4576
4577
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004578option external-check
4579 Use external processes for server health checks
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582
4583 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4584 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4585 command".
4586
4587 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4588
4589 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4590
4591
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004592option log-health-checks
4593no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004594 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | no | yes | yes
4597 Arguments : none
4598
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004599 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4600 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4601 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004602
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004603 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4604 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4605 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4606 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4607 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4608
4609 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4610 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004611
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004612 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4613 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4614 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004615
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004616
4617option log-separate-errors
4618no option log-separate-errors
4619 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | yes | yes | no
4622 Arguments : none
4623
4624 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4625 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4626 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4627 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4628 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4629 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4630 provides very important information.
4631
4632 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4633 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4634 error logs.
4635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004636 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004637 logging.
4638
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004639
4640option logasap
4641no option logasap
4642 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | no
4645 Arguments : none
4646
4647 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4648 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4649 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4650 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4651 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4652 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4653 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004654 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004655 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4656 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004658 Examples :
4659 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4660 mode http
4661 option httplog
4662 option logasap
4663 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4664
4665 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4666 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4667 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4668 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004670 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004671 logging.
4672
4673
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004674option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004675 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004678 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004679 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4680 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004681 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004682
4683 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4684 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4685 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4686 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4687 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4688 in the MySQL table, like this :
4689
4690 USE mysql;
4691 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4692 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4693
4694 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4695 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4696 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4697 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4698 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4699 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4700 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4701 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4702 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4703
4704 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4705 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004706
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004707 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004708
4709 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4710 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4711 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4712 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4713 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4714 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4715
4716 See also: "option httpchk"
4717
4718
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004719option nolinger
4720no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004721 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004724 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004725
4726 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4727 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4728 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4729 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4730 connections.
4731
4732 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4733 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4734 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4735 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4736 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4737 this too.
4738
4739 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4740 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4741 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4742
4743 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4744 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4745 for servers.
4746
4747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4749
4750
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004751option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4752 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 yes | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments :
4756 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4757 matching <network>
4758 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4759 header name.
4760
4761 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4762 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4763 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4764 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4765 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4766 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4767 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4768 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4769 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4770 possible that the client has already brought one.
4771
4772 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4773 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4774 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4775 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4776 header and requires different one.
4777
4778 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4779 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4780 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4781 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4782 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4783 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4784 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4785
4786 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4787 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4788 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4789 both are defined.
4790
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004791 Examples :
4792 # Original Destination address
4793 frontend www
4794 mode http
4795 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4796
4797 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4798 backend www
4799 mode http
4800 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4801
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004802 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4803 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004804
4805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004806option persist
4807no option persist
4808 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004812
4813 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4814 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4815 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4816 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4817 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4818 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4819 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4820 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4821 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4822 redirected to another valid server.
4823
4824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4826
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004827 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004828
4829
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004830option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4831 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 yes | no | yes | yes
4834 Arguments :
4835 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4836 PostgreSQL server.
4837
4838 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4839 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4840 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4841 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4842
4843 See also: "option httpchk"
4844
4845
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004846option prefer-last-server
4847no option prefer-last-server
4848 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4854 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4855 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4856 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4857 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4858 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4859 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4860 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4861 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004862 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4863 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4864 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4865 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4866 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4867 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4868 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004869
4870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4872
4873 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4874
4875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004876option redispatch
4877no option redispatch
4878 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004881 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004882
4883 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4884 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4885 be able to access the service anymore.
4886
4887 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4888 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4889
4890 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4891 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4892 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004894 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4895 "redisp" keywords.
4896
4897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4899
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004900 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004901
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004902
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004903option redis-check
4904 Use redis health checks for server testing
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
4907 Arguments : none
4908
4909 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4910 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4911 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4912 find the "+PONG" response message.
4913
4914 Example :
4915 option redis-check
4916
4917 See also : "option httpchk"
4918
4919
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004920option smtpchk
4921option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4922 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004925 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004926 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4927 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4928 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4929
4930 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4931 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4932 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4933
4934 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4935 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4936 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4937 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4938 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4939 dead server.
4940
4941 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4942 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4943 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4944 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4945
4946 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4947 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4948 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4949 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4950 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4951
4952 Example :
4953 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4954
4955 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004958option socket-stats
4959no option socket-stats
4960
4961 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | no
4964
4965 Arguments : none
4966
4967
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004968option splice-auto
4969no option splice-auto
4970 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | yes
4973 Arguments : none
4974
4975 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4976 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4977 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4978 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004979 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004980 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4981 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4982 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4983 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4984
4985 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4986 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4987 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4988 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4989 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4990 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4991 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4992 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4993 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4994 keyword.
4995
4996 Example :
4997 option splice-auto
4998
4999 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5000 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5001
5002 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5003 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5004
5005
5006option splice-request
5007no option splice-request
5008 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | yes | yes | yes
5011 Arguments : none
5012
5013 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005014 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005015 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5016 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5017 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5018 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5019
5020 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5021
5022 Example :
5023 option splice-request
5024
5025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5027
5028 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5029 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5030
5031
5032option splice-response
5033no option splice-response
5034 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments : none
5038
5039 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005040 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005041 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5042 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5043 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5044 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5045
5046 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5047
5048 Example :
5049 option splice-response
5050
5051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5053
5054 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5055 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5056
5057
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005058option srvtcpka
5059no option srvtcpka
5060 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063 Arguments : none
5064
5065 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5066 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5067 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5068 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5069
5070 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5071 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5072 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5073 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5074
5075 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5076 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5077 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5078 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5079 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5080
5081 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5082
5083 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5084 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5085 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5086
5087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5089
5090 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5091
5092
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005093option ssl-hello-chk
5094 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5100 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5101 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5102 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5103 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5104 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5105 hello message.
5106
5107 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5108 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5109 messages, which is appreciable.
5110
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005111 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5112 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5113 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005114
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005115 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5116
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005117
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005118option tcp-check
5119 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 yes | no | yes | yes
5122
5123 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5124 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5125
5126 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5127 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5128 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005130 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005131 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5132 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5133 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5134 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5135 only.
5136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005137 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005138 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5139 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5140 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5141 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5142
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005143 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005144 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5145 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005146 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005147 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5148 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5149 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5150 the respective protocols.
5151 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5152 analysed.
5153
5154 Examples :
5155 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5156 option tcp-check
5157 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5158
5159 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5160 option tcp-check
5161 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5162
5163 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5164 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005165 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005166 option tcp-check
5167 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5168 tcp-check expect +PONG
5169 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5170 tcp-check expect string role:master
5171 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5172 tcp-check expect string +OK
5173
5174 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5175 (send many headers before analyzing)
5176 option tcp-check
5177 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5178 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5179 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5180 tcp-check send \r\n
5181 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5182
5183
5184 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5185
5186
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005187option tcp-smart-accept
5188no option tcp-smart-accept
5189 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | yes | yes | no
5192 Arguments : none
5193
5194 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5195 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5196 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5197 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5198 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5199 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5200
5201 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5202 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5203 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5204 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5205
5206 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5207 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5208 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5209 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5210
5211 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5212 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5213 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5214
5215 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5216 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5217 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5218
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005219 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5220
5221
5222option tcp-smart-connect
5223no option tcp-smart-connect
5224 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments : none
5228
5229 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5230 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5231 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5232 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5233 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5234
5235 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5236 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5237 complex.
5238
5239 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5240 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5241 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5242
5243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5245
5246 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5247
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005248
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005249option tcpka
5250 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 yes | yes | yes | yes
5253 Arguments : none
5254
5255 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5256 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5257 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5258 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5259
5260 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5261 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5262 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5263 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5264
5265 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5266 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5267 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5268 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5269 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5270
5271 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5272
5273 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5274 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5275 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5276 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5277 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5278 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5279 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5280 backends.
5281
5282 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5283
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005284
5285option tcplog
5286 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | yes | yes | yes
5289 Arguments : none
5290
5291 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5292 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5293 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5294 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5295 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5296 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5297 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5298 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5299
5300 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005302 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005303
5304
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005305option transparent
5306no option transparent
5307 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005309 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005310 Arguments : none
5311
5312 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5313 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5314 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5315 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5316 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5317 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5318 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5319 appropriate server.
5320
5321 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5322 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5323
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005324 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005325 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005326
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005328external-check command <command>
5329 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 yes | no | yes | yes
5332
5333 Arguments :
5334 <command> is the external command to run
5335
5336 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5337 command may be set using "external-check path".
5338
5339 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5340
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005341 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005342
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005343 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5344 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5345 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5346 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5347 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5348 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005349
5350 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5351 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5352 failed.
5353
5354 Example :
5355 external-check command /bin/true
5356
5357 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5358
5359
5360external-check path <path>
5361 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | no | yes | yes
5364
5365 Arguments :
5366 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5367
5368 The default path is "".
5369
5370 Example :
5371 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5372
5373 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5374 "external-check command"
5375
5376
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005377persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005378persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005379 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5381 yes | no | yes | yes
5382 Arguments :
5383 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005384 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5385 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005386
5387 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5388 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5389 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5390 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5391 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5392 forwarded to this server.
5393
5394 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5395 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5396 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005397 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005398 a single "listen" section.
5399
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005400 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5401 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5402 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5403
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005404 Example :
5405 listen tse-farm
5406 bind :3389
5407 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5408 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5409 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5410 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5411 persist rdp-cookie
5412 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005413 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005414 balance rdp-cookie
5415 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5416 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5417
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005418 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5419 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005420
5421
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005422rate-limit sessions <rate>
5423 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 yes | yes | yes | no
5426 Arguments :
5427 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5428 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5429
5430 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5431 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5432 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5433 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5434 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5435 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5436
5437 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5438 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5439 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5440 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5441
5442 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5443 listen smtp
5444 mode tcp
5445 bind :25
5446 rate-limit sessions 10
5447 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5448
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005449 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5450 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5451 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005452
5453 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5454
5455
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005456redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5457redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5458redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005459 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 no | yes | yes | yes
5462
5463 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005464 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005465
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005466 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005467 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005468 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5469 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5470 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005471
5472 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5473 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5474 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5475 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5476 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005477 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5478 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5479 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5480 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005481
5482 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5483 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5484 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5485 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5486 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5487 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005488 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005489 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005490 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5491 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5492 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005493
5494 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005495 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5496 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5497 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5498 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5499 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5500 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5501 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5502 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005503
5504 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5505 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5506
5507 - "drop-query"
5508 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5509 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5510 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5511 with a location-type redirect.
5512
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005513 - "append-slash"
5514 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5515 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5516 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5517 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5518
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005519 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5520 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5521 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5522 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5523 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5524 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5525 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5526
5527 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5528 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5529 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5530 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5531 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5532 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5533 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005534
5535 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5536 acl clear dst_port 80
5537 acl secure dst_port 8080
5538 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005539 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005540 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005541 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5542
5543 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005544 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5545 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5546 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005547 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005548
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005549 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5550 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5551 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5552
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005553 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005554 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005555
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005556 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5557 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5558 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005560 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005561
5562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005563redisp (deprecated)
5564redispatch (deprecated)
5565 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005568 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005569
5570 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5571 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5572 be able to access the service anymore.
5573
5574 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5575 redistribute them to a working server.
5576
5577 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5578 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5579 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005581 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5582 "option redispatch" instead.
5583
5584 See also : "option redispatch"
5585
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005586
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005587reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005588 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5590 no | yes | yes | yes
5591 Arguments :
5592 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5593 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005594 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005595
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005596 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5597 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5598
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5600 the last header of an HTTP request.
5601
5602 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5603 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5604 responses.
5605
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005606 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5607 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5608 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5609
5610 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5611 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005612
5613
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005614reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5615reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 no | yes | yes | yes
5619 Arguments :
5620 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5621 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5622 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5623 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5624 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5625 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5626 ignores case.
5627
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005628 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5629 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5630
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005631 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5632 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5633 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5634 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005635 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636
5637 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5638 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5639
5640 Example :
5641 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5642 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5643 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5644
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005645 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5646 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005647
5648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005649reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5650reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 no | yes | yes | yes
5654 Arguments :
5655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5656 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5657 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5658 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5659 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5660 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005662 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5663 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5664
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5666 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5667 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5668 next servers.
5669
5670 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5671 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5672 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5673
5674 Example :
5675 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5676 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5677 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5678
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005679 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5680 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005681
5682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005683reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5684reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 no | yes | yes | yes
5688 Arguments :
5689 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5690 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5691 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5692 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5693 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5694 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5695 case.
5696
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005700 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5701 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5702 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5703 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005704 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005705
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005706 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005707 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005708 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005709
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005710 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5711 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5712
5713 Example :
5714 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5715 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5716 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5717
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005718 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5719 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005720
5721
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005722reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5723reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005724 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 no | yes | yes | yes
5727 Arguments :
5728 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5729 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5730 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5731 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5732 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5733 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5734 case.
5735
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005736 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5737 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5738
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005739 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5740 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5741 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5742 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5743
5744 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5745 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5746
5747 Example :
5748 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5749 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5750 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5751 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005753 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5754 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005755
5756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005757reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5758reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005759 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5761 no | yes | yes | yes
5762 Arguments :
5763 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5764 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5765 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5766 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5767 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5768 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5769
5770 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5771 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5772 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5773 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005774 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005776 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5777 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5778
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005779 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5780 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5781 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5782
5783 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5784 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5785 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5786 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5787 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5788
5789 Example :
5790 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005791 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005792 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5793 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5794
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005795 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5796 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005797
5798
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005799reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5800reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 no | yes | yes | yes
5804 Arguments :
5805 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5806 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5807 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5808 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5809 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5810 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5811 ignores case.
5812
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005813 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5814 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5815
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005816 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5817 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005818 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5819 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5820 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005821 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5822 not set.
5823
5824 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5825 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5826 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5827 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5828 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5829
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005830 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005831 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5832 # block all others.
5833 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5834 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5835
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005836 # block bad guys
5837 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5838 reqitarpit . if badguys
5839
5840 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5841 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005842
5843
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005844retries <value>
5845 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | no | yes | yes
5848 Arguments :
5849 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5850 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5851 default value is 3.
5852
5853 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5854 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5855 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5856
5857 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5858 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5859
5860 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5861 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5862
5863 See also : "option redispatch"
5864
5865
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005866rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005867 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 no | yes | yes | yes
5870 Arguments :
5871 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5872 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005873 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005875 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5876 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5877
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005878 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5879 the last header of an HTTP response.
5880
5881 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5882 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5883 responses.
5884
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005885 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5886 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005887
5888
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005889rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5890rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005891 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5893 no | yes | yes | yes
5894 Arguments :
5895 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5896 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5897 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5898 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5899 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5900 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5901 ignores case.
5902
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005903 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5904 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5905
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005906 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5907 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005908 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005909 client.
5910
5911 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5912 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5913 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5914
5915 Example :
5916 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005917 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005918
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005919 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5920 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005921
5922
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005923rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5924rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005925 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5927 no | yes | yes | yes
5928 Arguments :
5929 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5930 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5931 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5932 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5933 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5934 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5935 ignores case.
5936
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005937 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5938 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5939
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005940 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5941 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5942 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5943 case-sensitive.
5944
5945 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005946 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5947 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5948 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005949
5950 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5951 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5952
5953 Example :
5954 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5955 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5956
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005957 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5958 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005959
5960
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005961rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5962rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005963 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 no | yes | yes | yes
5966 Arguments :
5967 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5968 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5969 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5970 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5971 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5972 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5973 ignores case.
5974
5975 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5976 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5977 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5978 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005979 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005980
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005981 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5982 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5983
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005984 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5985 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5986 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5987
5988 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5989 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5990 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5991 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5992 are not case-sensitive.
5993
5994 Example :
5995 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5996 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5997
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005998 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5999 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006000
6001
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006002server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006003 Declare a server in a backend
6004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6005 no | no | yes | yes
6006 Arguments :
6007 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006008 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006009 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006010
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006011 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6012 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6013 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6014 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006015 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6016 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6017 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6018 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6019 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006020 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6021 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6022 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6023 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6024 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6025 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6026 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006027 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006028 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6029 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6030 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6031 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006033 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006034 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6035 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6036 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6037 adding this value to the client's port.
6038
6039 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6040 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006041 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006042
6043 Examples :
6044 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6045 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006046 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006047 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6048 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6049 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006050
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006051 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6052 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006053
6054
6055source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006056source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006057source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006058 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 yes | no | yes | yes
6061 Arguments :
6062 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6063 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006064
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006065 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006066 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6067 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6068 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6069 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6070 supported prefixes are :
6071 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6072 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6073 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006074 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006075 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6076 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6077 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6078 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006079
6080 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6081 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006082 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6083 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6084 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006085
6086 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6087 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6088 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6089 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6090 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6091 <addr>.
6092
6093 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6094 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6095 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6096 port.
6097
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006098 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6099 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6100 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6101 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006102 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006103 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6104 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6105 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6106 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6107 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6108 HTTP header.
6109
6110 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6111 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006112 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006113 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6114 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6115 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6116 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6117 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6118 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6119 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6120
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006121 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6122 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6123 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6124 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6125 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6126 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6127
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006128 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6129 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6130 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6131 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6132
6133 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6134 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6135 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6136 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6137 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6138 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6139
6140 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6141 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6142 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6143 there are two methods :
6144
6145 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6146 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6147 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6148 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6149 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6150 of the client ranges may be used.
6151
6152 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6153 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6154 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6155 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6156 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6157 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6158 same session.
6159
6160 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6161 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6162 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6163 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6164 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6165 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6166
6167 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6168 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6169 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006170 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006171
6172 Examples :
6173 backend private
6174 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6175 source 192.168.1.200
6176
6177 backend transparent_ssl1
6178 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6179 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6180
6181 backend transparent_ssl2
6182 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6183 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6184 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6185
6186 backend transparent_ssl3
6187 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6188 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6189 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6190
6191 backend transparent_smtp
6192 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6193 # with Tproxy version 4.
6194 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6195
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006196 backend transparent_http
6197 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6198 # proxy.
6199 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006201 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006202 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006204
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006205srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6208 yes | no | yes | yes
6209 Arguments :
6210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6212 as explained at the top of this document.
6213
6214 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6216 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6217 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6218 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6219 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6220 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6221
6222 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6223 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6224 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6225 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6226 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006227 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006228 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006229 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006230
6231 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6232 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6233 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6234 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6235 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6236 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6237
6238 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6239 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6240
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006241 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6242 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006243
6244
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006245stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6246 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006248 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006249
6250 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6251 matched.
6252
6253 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6254 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6255
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006256 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6257 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6258 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6259
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006260 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6261 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6262 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6263 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006264
6265 Example :
6266 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6267 backend stats_localhost
6268 stats enable
6269 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6270
6271 Example :
6272 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6273 backend stats_auth
6274 stats enable
6275 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6276 stats admin if TRUE
6277
6278 Example :
6279 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6280 userlist stats-auth
6281 group admin users admin
6282 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6283 group readonly users haproxy
6284 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6285
6286 backend stats_auth
6287 stats enable
6288 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6289 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6290 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6291 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6292
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006293 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6294 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6295 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006296
6297
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006298stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6299 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006301 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006302 Arguments :
6303 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6304
6305 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6306
6307 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6308 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6309 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6310 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6311 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6312 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6313
6314 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6315 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6316 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006317 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006318
6319 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6320 report using "stats scope".
6321
6322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6324 unobvious parameters.
6325
6326 Example :
6327 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6328 backend public_www
6329 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6330 stats enable
6331 stats hide-version
6332 stats scope .
6333 stats uri /admin?stats
6334 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6335 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6336 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6337
6338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6339 backend private_monitoring
6340 stats enable
6341 stats uri /admin?stats
6342 stats refresh 5s
6343
6344 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6345
6346
6347stats enable
6348 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006350 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006351 Arguments : none
6352
6353 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6354 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6355 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6356 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6357 - stats auth : no authentication
6358 - stats scope : no restriction
6359
6360 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6361 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6362 unobvious parameters.
6363
6364 Example :
6365 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6366 backend public_www
6367 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6368 stats enable
6369 stats hide-version
6370 stats scope .
6371 stats uri /admin?stats
6372 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6373 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6374 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6375
6376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6377 backend private_monitoring
6378 stats enable
6379 stats uri /admin?stats
6380 stats refresh 5s
6381
6382 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6383
6384
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006385stats hide-version
6386 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006389 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006390
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006391 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6392 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6393 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6394 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6395 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6396 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006398 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6399 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6400 unobvious parameters.
6401
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006402 Example :
6403 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6404 backend public_www
6405 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006406 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006407 stats hide-version
6408 stats scope .
6409 stats uri /admin?stats
6410 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6411 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6412 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006413
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006414 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6415 backend private_monitoring
6416 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006417 stats uri /admin?stats
6418 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006419
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006420 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006421
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006422
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006423stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6425 Access control for statistics
6426
6427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6428 no | no | yes | yes
6429
6430 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6431 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6432 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6433 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6434 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6435 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6436
6437 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6438 instance.
6439
6440 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6441 about ACL usage.
6442
6443
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006444stats realm <realm>
6445 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006448 Arguments :
6449 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6450 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6451 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6452
6453 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6454 using a backslash ('\').
6455
6456 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6457 only related to authentication.
6458
6459 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6460 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6461 unobvious parameters.
6462
6463 Example :
6464 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6465 backend public_www
6466 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6467 stats enable
6468 stats hide-version
6469 stats scope .
6470 stats uri /admin?stats
6471 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6472 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6473 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6474
6475 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6476 backend private_monitoring
6477 stats enable
6478 stats uri /admin?stats
6479 stats refresh 5s
6480
6481 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6482
6483
6484stats refresh <delay>
6485 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006488 Arguments :
6489 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6490 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6491 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6492 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6493 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6494 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6495
6496 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6497 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6498 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6499 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6500
6501 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6502 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6503 unobvious parameters.
6504
6505 Example :
6506 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6507 backend public_www
6508 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6509 stats enable
6510 stats hide-version
6511 stats scope .
6512 stats uri /admin?stats
6513 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6514 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6515 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6516
6517 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6518 backend private_monitoring
6519 stats enable
6520 stats uri /admin?stats
6521 stats refresh 5s
6522
6523 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6524
6525
6526stats scope { <name> | "." }
6527 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006529 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006530 Arguments :
6531 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6532 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6533 section in which the statement appears.
6534
6535 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6536 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6537 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6538 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6539 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6540 exists.
6541
6542 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6543 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6544 unobvious parameters.
6545
6546 Example :
6547 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6548 backend public_www
6549 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6550 stats enable
6551 stats hide-version
6552 stats scope .
6553 stats uri /admin?stats
6554 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6555 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6556 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6557
6558 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6559 backend private_monitoring
6560 stats enable
6561 stats uri /admin?stats
6562 stats refresh 5s
6563
6564 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6565
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006567stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006568 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006570 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006571
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006572 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006573 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6574
6575 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6576 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6577
6578 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6579 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006580 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006581
6582 Example :
6583 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6584 backend private_monitoring
6585 stats enable
6586 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6587 stats uri /admin?stats
6588 stats refresh 5s
6589
6590 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6591 global section.
6592
6593
6594stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006595 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | yes | yes | yes
6598 Arguments : none
6599
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006600 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006601 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6602 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6603 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6604 - IP (socket, server)
6605 - cookie (backend, server)
6606
6607 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6608 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006609 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006610
6611 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6612
6613
6614stats show-node [ <name> ]
6615 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006617 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006618 Arguments:
6619 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6620 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6621
6622 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6623 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006624 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006625
6626 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6627 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6628 unobvious parameters.
6629
6630 Example:
6631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6632 backend private_monitoring
6633 stats enable
6634 stats show-node Europe-1
6635 stats uri /admin?stats
6636 stats refresh 5s
6637
6638 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6639 section.
6640
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006641
6642stats uri <prefix>
6643 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006645 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006646 Arguments :
6647 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6648 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6649 query string.
6650
6651 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6652 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6653 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6654 possible to reach it in the application.
6655
6656 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006657 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006658 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6659 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6660 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6661 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6662
6663 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6664 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6665 an address or a port to statistics only.
6666
6667 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6668 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6669 unobvious parameters.
6670
6671 Example :
6672 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6673 backend public_www
6674 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6675 stats enable
6676 stats hide-version
6677 stats scope .
6678 stats uri /admin?stats
6679 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6680 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6681 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6682
6683 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6684 backend private_monitoring
6685 stats enable
6686 stats uri /admin?stats
6687 stats refresh 5s
6688
6689 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6690
6691
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006692stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6693 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006695 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006696
6697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006698 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006699 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6700 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6701 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6702
6703 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6704 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6705 the "stick-table" statement.
6706
6707 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6708 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6709 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6710 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6711 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6712
6713 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6714 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6715 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6716 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6717 transformation rules.
6718
6719 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6720 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6721 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6722 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6723 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6724 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6725 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6726
6727 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6728 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6729 ACL based conditions.
6730
6731 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6732 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6733 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6734 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6735
6736 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6737 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6738 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6739 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6740
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006741 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6742 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6743 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006745 Example :
6746 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6747 # last 30 minutes
6748 backend pop
6749 mode tcp
6750 balance roundrobin
6751 stick store-request src
6752 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6753 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6754 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6755
6756 backend smtp
6757 mode tcp
6758 balance roundrobin
6759 stick match src table pop
6760 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6761 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6762
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006763 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006764 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006765
6766
6767stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6768 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6770 no | no | yes | yes
6771
6772 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6773 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6774 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6775 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6776
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006777 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6778 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6779 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6780
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006781 Examples :
6782 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006783 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006784
6785 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6786 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6787 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6788
6789
6790 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6791 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6792 backend http
6793 mode http
6794 balance roundrobin
6795 stick on src table https
6796 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6797 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6798 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6799
6800 backend https
6801 mode tcp
6802 balance roundrobin
6803 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6804 stick on src
6805 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6806 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006808 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006809
6810
6811stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6812 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 no | no | yes | yes
6815
6816 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006817 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006818 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6819 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6820 server is selected.
6821
6822 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6823 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6824 the "stick-table" statement.
6825
6826 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6827 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6828 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6829 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6830 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6831 address.
6832
6833 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6834 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6835 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6836 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6837 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6838 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6839 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6840 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6841 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6842 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6843
6844 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6845 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6846 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6847 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6848 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6849 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6850 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6851
6852 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6853 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6854 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6855 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6856
6857 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6858 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6859 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6860 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6861 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6862 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006863 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6864 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6865 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6866 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6867 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6868 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006869
6870 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6871 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6872 the request.
6873
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006874 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6875 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6876 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006878 Example :
6879 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6880 # last 30 minutes
6881 backend pop
6882 mode tcp
6883 balance roundrobin
6884 stick store-request src
6885 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6886 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6887 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6888
6889 backend smtp
6890 mode tcp
6891 balance roundrobin
6892 stick match src table pop
6893 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6894 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6895
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006896 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006897 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006898
6899
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006900stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006901 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6902 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006903 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006905 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006906
6907 Arguments :
6908 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6909 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6910 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6911 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6912
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006913 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6914 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6915 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6916 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6917
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006918 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6919 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6920 instance.
6921
6922 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6923 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6924 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6925 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6926 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6927 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006928 to 32 characters.
6929
6930 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6931 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6932 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006933 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006934 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6935 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006936
6937 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006938 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6939 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006940 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6941 increase.
6942
6943 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006944 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6945 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6946 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006947
6948 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6949 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6950 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6951 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6952 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6953 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6954 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6955 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6956 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6957 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6958 parameter (see below).
6959
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006960 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6961 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6962 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6963 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6964 soft restart.
6965
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006966 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6967
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006968 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6969 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6970 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6971 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6972 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006973 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006974 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6975 if not expiration delay is specified.
6976
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006977 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6978 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6979 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6980 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006981 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6982 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6983 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6984 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6985 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6986 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6987 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6988 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6989 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6990 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6991 types and their arguments.
6992
6993 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6994 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6995 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6996 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6997
6998 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6999 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7000 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7001 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7002
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007003 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7004 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7005 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7006 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7007 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7008 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7009
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007010 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7011 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7012 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7013 they were received.
7014
7015 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7016 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7017 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7018 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7019 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7020
7021 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7022 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7023 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7024 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7025 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7026
7027 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7028 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7029 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7030
7031 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7032 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7033 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7034 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7035 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7036
7037 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7038 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7039 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7040 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7041 the client side.
7042
7043 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7044 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7045 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7046 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7047 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7048 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7049 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7050
7051 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7052 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7053 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7054 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7055 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7056 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7057 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7058
7059 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7060 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7061 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7062 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7063 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7064 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7065
7066 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7067 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7068 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7069 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7070
7071 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7072 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7073 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7074 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7075 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7076 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7077 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7078 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7079 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7080 recommended for better fairness.
7081
7082 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7083 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7084 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7085 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7086
7087 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7088 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7089 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7090 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7091 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7092 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7093 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7094 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7095 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7096 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007097
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007098 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7099 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007100 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7101 reference it.
7102
7103 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7104 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7105 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7106 as an exclusive stickiness.
7107
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007108 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7109 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7110 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7111 something that can be ignored.
7112
7113 Example:
7114 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7115 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7116 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7117 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7118
7119 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007120 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007121
7122
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007123stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7124 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 no | no | yes | yes
7127
7128 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007129 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007130 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7131 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7132 server is selected.
7133
7134 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7135 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7136 the "stick-table" statement.
7137
7138 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7139 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7140 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7141 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7142
7143 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7144 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7145 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7146 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7147 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7148 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007149 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007150 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7151 rules.
7152
7153 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7154 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7155 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7156 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7157 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7158 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7159 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7160
7161 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7162 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7163 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7164 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7165
7166 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7167 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7168 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7169 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7170 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7171 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007172 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7173 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7174 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7175 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7176 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7177 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7178 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7179 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7180 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007181
7182 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7183
7184 Example :
7185 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7186 backend https
7187 mode tcp
7188 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007189 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007190 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007191
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007192 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7193 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7194
7195 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7196 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7197 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7198
7199 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7200 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007201
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007202 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7203 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7204 # at offset 44.
7205
7206 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7207 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7208
7209 # Learn on response if server hello.
7210 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007211
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007212 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7213 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7214
7215 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7216 extraction.
7217
7218
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007219tcp-check connect [params*]
7220 Opens a new connection
7221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 no | no | yes | yes
7223
7224 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7225 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7226 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7227
7228 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7229 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7230 of the sequence.
7231
7232 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7233 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7234 do.
7235
7236 Parameters :
7237 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7238 use the TCP connection.
7239
7240 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7241 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7242 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7243
7244 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7245
7246 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7247
7248 Examples:
7249 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7250 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7251 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7252 option tcp-check
7253 tcp-check connect
7254 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7255 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7256 tcp-check send \r\n
7257 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7258 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7259 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7260 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7261 tcp-check send \r\n
7262 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7263 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7264
7265 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7266 option tcp-check
7267 tcp-check connect port 110
7268 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7269 tcp-check connect port 143
7270 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7271 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7272
7273 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7274
7275
7276tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7277 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7279 no | no | yes | yes
7280
7281 Arguments :
7282 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7283 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7284 binary.
7285 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7286 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7287 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7288
7289 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7290 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7291 with the usual backslash ('\').
7292 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7293 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7294 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7295 used upper or lower case.
7296
7297
7298 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7299
7300 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7301 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7302 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7303 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7304 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7305 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7306 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7307 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7308
7309 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7310 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7311 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7312 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7313 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7314 expression.
7315
7316 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7317 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7318 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7319 this exact hexadecimal string.
7320 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7321
7322 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7323 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7324 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7325 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7326 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7327 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7328 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7329 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7330 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7331 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7332 the null character.
7333
7334 Examples :
7335 # perform a POP check
7336 option tcp-check
7337 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7338
7339 # perform an IMAP check
7340 option tcp-check
7341 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7342
7343 # look for the redis master server
7344 option tcp-check
7345 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7346 tcp-check expect +PONG
7347 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7348 tcp-check expect string role:master
7349 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7350 tcp-check expect string +OK
7351
7352
7353 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7354 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7355
7356
7357tcp-check send <data>
7358 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 no | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7363 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7364
7365 Examples :
7366 # look for the redis master server
7367 option tcp-check
7368 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7369 tcp-check expect string role:master
7370
7371 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7372 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7373
7374
7375tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7376 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7377 tcp health check
7378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7379 no | no | yes | yes
7380
7381 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7382 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7383 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7384 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7385 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7386 hexadecimal string.
7387 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7388
7389 Examples :
7390 # redis check in binary
7391 option tcp-check
7392 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7393 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7394
7395
7396 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7397 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7398
7399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007400tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7401 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7403 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007404 Arguments :
7405 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007406 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7407 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007409 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007410
7411 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7412 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007413 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7414 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7415 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7416 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7417 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7418 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007420 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7421 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7422 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7423 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007424
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007425 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 - accept :
7427 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7428 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7429 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431 - reject :
7432 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7433 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7434 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7435 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7436 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7437 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7438 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7439 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7440 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7441 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7442 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7443 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007444
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007445 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7446 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7447 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7448 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7449 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7450 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7451 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7452 hosts.
7453
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007454 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7455 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7456 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7457 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7458 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7459 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7460 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7461 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7462 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7463 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7464 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7465
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007466 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007467 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007468 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007469 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007470 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7471 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007472 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007473 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7474 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7475 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7476 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7477 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007479 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007480 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007481 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007482 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7483 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7484 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7485 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7488 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7489 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7490 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007492 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7493 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7494 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7495 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7496 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007497 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7498 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7499 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7500 layer7 information is extracted.
7501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007502 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7503 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7504 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7505 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7506 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007507
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007508 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7509 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7510 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007512 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7513 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7514 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007515
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007516 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007517 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007518 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007520 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7521 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7522 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007524 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007525 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7526 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007527
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007528 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7529
7530 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7531
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007532 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007535
7536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007537tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7538 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007540 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007541 Arguments :
7542 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007543 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007544 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7545 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007546
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007549 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7550 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7551 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7552 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7553 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007555 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7556 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7557 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7558 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007559 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7560 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7561 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7562 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7563 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7564 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007565 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007566 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007568 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7569 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7570 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7571 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007572
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007573 Four types of actions are supported :
7574 - accept : the request is accepted
7575 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7576 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007577 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007579 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7580 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007581
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007582 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7583 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7584 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7585 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7586 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7587 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007589 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007590 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7591 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007593 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007594 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7595 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7596 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7597 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007598 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7599 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7600 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007602 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007603 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7604 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7605 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007606
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007607 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007608 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7609 # and reject everything else.
7610 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7611 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007612 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007613 tcp-request content reject
7614
7615 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007616 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7617 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7618 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007619 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007620
7621 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7622 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7623 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007624 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007625 tcp-request content reject
7626
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007627 Example:
7628 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7629 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007630 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007631
7632 Example:
7633 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7634 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007635 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007637 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7638 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7639
7640 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007641 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007642 # protecting all our sites
7643 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007644 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7645 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007646 ...
7647 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7648
7649 backend http_dynamic
7650 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007651 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007652 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007653 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7654 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7655 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007656 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007658 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007660 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007661
7662
7663tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7664 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007666 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007667 Arguments :
7668 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7669 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7670 as explained at the top of this document.
7671
7672 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7673 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7674 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7675 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7676 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7677
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007678 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7679 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7680 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7681 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7682
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007683 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7684 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007685 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007686 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007687 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7688 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7689 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7690 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007691
7692 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7693 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7694 it pass through unaffected.
7695
7696 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7697 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7698 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007699 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007700 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7701 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007702 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7703 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7704 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007705
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007706 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007707 "timeout client".
7708
7709
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007710tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7711 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 no | no | yes | yes
7714 Arguments :
7715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007716 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007717
7718 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7719
7720 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7721 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7722 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007723 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7724 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007725
7726 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7727
7728 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7729 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7730 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7731 inserted.
7732
7733 Two types of actions are supported :
7734 - accept :
7735 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7736 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7737 the rules evaluation.
7738
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007739 - close :
7740 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7741 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7742 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7743 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7744 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7745 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007746 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007747 protocols.
7748
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007749 - reject :
7750 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7751 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007752 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007753
7754 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7755 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7756 for changing the default action to a reject.
7757
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007758 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7759 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7760 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7761 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007762 period.
7763
7764 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7765
7766 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7767
7768
7769tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7770 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7772 no | no | yes | yes
7773 Arguments :
7774 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7776 as explained at the top of this document.
7777
7778 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7779
7780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007781timeout check <timeout>
7782 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7783 established.
7784
7785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7786 yes | no | yes | yes
7787 Arguments:
7788 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7789 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7790 as explained at the top of this document.
7791
7792 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7793 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7794 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7795 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007796 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7797 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7798 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007799
7800 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7801 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7802
7803 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7804 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007805 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007806
7807 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7808 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7809 forget about it.
7810
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007811 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7812 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007813
7814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007815timeout client <timeout>
7816timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7817 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7819 yes | yes | yes | no
7820 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007821 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007822 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7823 as explained at the top of this document.
7824
7825 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7826 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7827 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7828 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7829 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7830 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7831 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7832 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007833 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007834 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007835 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7836 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007837 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7838 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007839
7840 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7841 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7842 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7843 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7844 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7845 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7846
7847 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7848 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7849 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7850
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007851 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007852
7853
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007854timeout client-fin <timeout>
7855 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | yes | yes | no
7858 Arguments :
7859 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7861 as explained at the top of this document.
7862
7863 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7864 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7865 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7866 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7867 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7868 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7869 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7870 down in one direction.
7871
7872 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7873 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7874 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7875
7876 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7877
7878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007879timeout connect <timeout>
7880timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7881 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 yes | no | yes | yes
7884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7887 as explained at the top of this document.
7888
7889 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007890 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007891 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007892 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007893 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7894 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007895
7896 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7897 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7898 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7899 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7900 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7901 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7902
7903 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7904 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7905 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7906
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007907 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7908 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007909
7910
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007911timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7912 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7914 yes | yes | yes | yes
7915 Arguments :
7916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7918 as explained at the top of this document.
7919
7920 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7921 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7922 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7923 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7924 once the request has started to present itself.
7925
7926 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7927 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7928 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7929 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7930 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7931
7932 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7933 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7934 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7935 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7936
7937 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7938 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7939 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7940 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7941 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007942 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007943
7944 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7945 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7946 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7947 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7948
7949 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7950
7951
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007952timeout http-request <timeout>
7953 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007955 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007956 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007957 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007958 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7959 as explained at the top of this document.
7960
7961 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7962 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7963 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7964 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7965 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7966 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7967 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007968 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7969 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7970 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7971 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7972 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7973 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7974 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007975
7976 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7977 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007978 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7979 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007980
7981 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7982 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7983 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7984 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7985 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7986
7987 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007988 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7989 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7990 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007991
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007992 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007993
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007994
7995timeout queue <timeout>
7996 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | no | yes | yes
7999 Arguments :
8000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8002 as explained at the top of this document.
8003
8004 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8005 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8006 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8007 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8008 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8009
8010 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8011 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8012 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8013 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8014
8015 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8016
8017
8018timeout server <timeout>
8019timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8020 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | no | yes | yes
8023 Arguments :
8024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8026 as explained at the top of this document.
8027
8028 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8029 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8030 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8031 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8032 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8033 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8034 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8035
8036 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8037 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8038 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8039 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8040 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008041 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008042 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008043 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8044 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8045 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8046 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008047
8048 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8049 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8050 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8051 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8052 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8053 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8054
8055 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8056 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8057 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8058
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008059 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008060
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008061
8062timeout server-fin <timeout>
8063 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | no | yes | yes
8066 Arguments :
8067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8069 as explained at the top of this document.
8070
8071 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8072 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8073 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8074 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8075 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8076 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8077 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8078 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8079 situations, it should not be needed.
8080
8081 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8082 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8083 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8084
8085 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008087
8088timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008089 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 yes | yes | yes | yes
8092 Arguments :
8093 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8094 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8095 as explained at the top of this document.
8096
8097 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8098 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8099 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8100
8101 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8102 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8103 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8104 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008105 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008106
8107 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8108
8109
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008110timeout tunnel <timeout>
8111 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8113 yes | no | yes | yes
8114 Arguments :
8115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8117 as explained at the top of this document.
8118
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008119 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008120 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8121 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8122 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8123 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8124 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8125 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8126 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8127 specified.
8128
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008129 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8130 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8131 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8132 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8133 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8134 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8135 state.
8136
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008137 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8138 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8139 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8140 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8141 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8142
8143 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8144 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8145 forget about it.
8146
8147 Example :
8148 defaults http
8149 option http-server-close
8150 timeout connect 5s
8151 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008152 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008153 timeout server 30s
8154 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8155
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008156 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008157
8158
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008159transparent (deprecated)
8160 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008162 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008163 Arguments : none
8164
8165 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8166 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8167 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8168 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8169 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8170 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8171 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8172 appropriate server.
8173
8174 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8175
8176 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8177 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8178
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008179 See also: "option transparent"
8180
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008181unique-id-format <string>
8182 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | yes | yes | no
8185 Arguments :
8186 <string> is a log-format string.
8187
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008188 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8189 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8190 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8191 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008192
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008193 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8194 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8195 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8196 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8197 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8198 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8199 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8200 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008202 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8203 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008205 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008206
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008207 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008208
8209 will generate:
8210
8211 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8212
8213 See also: "unique-id-header"
8214
8215unique-id-header <name>
8216 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | yes | yes | no
8219 Arguments :
8220 <name> is the name of the header.
8221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008222 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8223 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008225 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008226
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008227 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008228 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8229
8230 will generate:
8231
8232 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8233
8234 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008235
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008236use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008237 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 no | yes | yes | no
8240 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008241 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8242 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008243
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008244 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8245 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008246
8247 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8248 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8249 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008250 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8251 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8252 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8253 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008254
8255 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8256 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8257 assign the backend.
8258
8259 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8260 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8261 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8262 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8263 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8264 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8265
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008266 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008267 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008268 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8269 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8270 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8271
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008272 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8273 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8274 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8275 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8276 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8277 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8278 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8279 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8280 cannot be forced from the request.
8281
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008282 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008283 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8284 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8285
8286 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8287 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008288
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008289
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008290use-server <server> if <condition>
8291use-server <server> unless <condition>
8292 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 no | no | yes | yes
8295 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008296 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008297
8298 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8299
8300 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8301 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8302 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8303
8304 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8305 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8306 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8307 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8308 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8309 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8310 matches will assign the server.
8311
8312 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8313 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8314 with the next rules until one matches.
8315
8316 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8317 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8318 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8319 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8320
8321 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8322 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8323 stripped.
8324
8325 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8326 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8327 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8328 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8329
8330 Example :
8331 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8332 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8333 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8334 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8335 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8336 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8337 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8338 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8339 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8340
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008341 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008343
83445. Bind and Server options
8345--------------------------
8346
8347The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8348depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8349settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8350written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8351described in this section.
8352
8353
83545.1. Bind options
8355-----------------
8356
8357The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8358as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8359no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8360parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8361while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8362provided immediately after the setting name.
8363
8364The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8365
8366accept-proxy
8367 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008368 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8369 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008370 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8371 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8372 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8373 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8374 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8375 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8376 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008377 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8378 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008379
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008380alpn <protocols>
8381 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8382 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8383 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8384 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8385 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8386 initial NPN extension.
8387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008388backlog <backlog>
8389 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8390 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8391
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008392ecdhe <named curve>
8393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008394 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8395 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008396
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008397ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8399 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8400 client's certificate.
8401
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008402ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8404 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8405 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8406 error is ignored.
8407
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008408ciphers <ciphers>
8409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8410 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008411 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008412 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8413 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8414
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008415crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008416 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8417 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8418 to verify client's certificate.
8419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008420crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8422 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8423 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8424 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8425 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8426 file.
8427
8428 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8429 are loaded.
8430
8431 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008432 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8433 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008434 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8435 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8436 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8437 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8438 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8439 www.sub.example.org).
8440
8441 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8442 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8443 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8444 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8445 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8446
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008447 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008448
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008449 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8450 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008451 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008452 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8453 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8454 clients).
8455
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008456 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8457 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8458 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8459 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8460 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8461 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8462 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8463 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8464 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8465 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8466 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8467 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8468 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8469
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008470crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8472 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008473 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008474 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008475
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008476crt-list <file>
8477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008478 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8479 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008480
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008481 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008482
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008483 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8484 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8485 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8486 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8487 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8488 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8489 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8490 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008491
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008492defer-accept
8493 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8494 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8495 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8496 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8497 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8498 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8499 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8500 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8501 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8502 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8503 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8504
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008505force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008506 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008507 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008508 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8509 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008510
8511force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008512 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008513 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8514 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008515
8516force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008517 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008518 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8519 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008520
8521force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008522 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008523 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8524 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008525
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008526gid <gid>
8527 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8528 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8529 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8530 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8531 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8532
8533group <group>
8534 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8535 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8536 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8537 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8538 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8539
8540id <id>
8541 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8542 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8543 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8544 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8545
8546interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008547 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8548 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8549 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8550 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8551 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8552 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8553 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008554
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008555level <level>
8556 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8557 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8558 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8559 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8560 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8561 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8562 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8563 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8564 counters).
8565 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8566 all counters).
8567
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008568maxconn <maxconn>
8569 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8570 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8571 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8572 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8573 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8574 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8575 eat all memory.
8576
8577mode <mode>
8578 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8579 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8580 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8581 UNIX sockets.
8582
8583mss <maxseg>
8584 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8585 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8586 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8587 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8588 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8589 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8590 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8591 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8592 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8593 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8594 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8595
8596name <name>
8597 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8598 page.
8599
8600nice <nice>
8601 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8602 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8603 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8604 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8605 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8606 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8607 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8608 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8609 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8610 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8611 one for an RDP socket.
8612
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008613no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008615 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008616 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008617 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8618 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008619 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008620
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008621no-tls-tickets
8622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8623 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8624 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008625 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8626 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008627
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008628no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008630 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008631 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008632 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8633 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8634 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008635
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008636no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008638 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008639 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008640 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8641 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8642 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008643
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008644no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008646 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008647 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008648 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8649 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8650 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008651
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008652npn <protocols>
8653 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8654 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8655 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8656 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008657 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8658 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008659
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008660process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8661 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8662 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8663 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8664 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8665 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8666 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8667 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008668 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8669 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8670 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8671 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8672 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8673 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8674 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008676ssl
8677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008678 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008679 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8680 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8681 to deciphered contents.
8682
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008683strict-sni
8684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8685 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8686 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8687 See the "crt" option for more information.
8688
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008689tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008690 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008691 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8692 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8693 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8694 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8695 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8696 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8697 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008698 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8699 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8700 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008702transparent
8703 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8704 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8705 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8706 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8707 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8708 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8709 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8710 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8711 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8712 so check for support with your vendor.
8713
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008714v4v6
8715 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8716 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8717 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8718 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008719 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008720
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008721v6only
8722 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8723 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8724 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008725 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8726 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008728uid <uid>
8729 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8730 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8731 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8732 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8733 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8734
8735user <user>
8736 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8737 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8738 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8739 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8740 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8741
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008742verify [none|optional|required]
8743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8744 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8745 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8746 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8747 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008748 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8749 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8750 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8751 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087535.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008754------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008756The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8757which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8758arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8759settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8760after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8761Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8762address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008764 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008765 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008767The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008768
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008769addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008770 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8771 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8772 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8773 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8774 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008776 Supported in default-server: No
8777
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008778agent-check
8779 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008780 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8781 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8782 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8783 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008784
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008785 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008786 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008787 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8788 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8789 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008790
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008791 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8792 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008793
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008794 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8795 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8796 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008797
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008798 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8799 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8800 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008801
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008802 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8803 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8804 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8805 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8806 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8807 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8808 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008809
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008810 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8811 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008812
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008813 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8814 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8815 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8816 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8817 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8818 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8819 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8820 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8821 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008822
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008823 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8824 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008825 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8826 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8827 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8828 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008829
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008830 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8831 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008832
8833 Supported in default-server: No
8834
8835agent-inter <delay>
8836 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8837 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8838
8839 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8840 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8841 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8842 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8843 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8844 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8845 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8846 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8847 of backends use the same servers.
8848
8849 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8850
8851 Supported in default-server: Yes
8852
8853agent-port <port>
8854 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8855
8856 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8857
8858 Supported in default-server: Yes
8859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008860backup
8861 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8862 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8863 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8864 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8865 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8866 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008868 Supported in default-server: No
8869
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008870ca-file <cafile>
8871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8872 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8873 server's certificate.
8874
8875 Supported in default-server: No
8876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008877check
8878 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008879 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8880 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8881 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8882 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8883 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8884 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8885 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008886 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8887 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8888 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008890 Supported in default-server: No
8891
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008892check-send-proxy
8893 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8894 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8895 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8896 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8897 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8898 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8899 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8900
8901 Supported in default-server: No
8902
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008903check-ssl
8904 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8905 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8906 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8907 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008908 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008909 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8910 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8911 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8912 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8913
8914 Supported in default-server: No
8915
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008916ciphers <ciphers>
8917 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008918 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008919 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8920 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8921 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8922 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8923 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8924 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8925
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008926 Supported in default-server: No
8927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008928cookie <value>
8929 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8930 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8931 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8932 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8933 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8934 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8935 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008937 Supported in default-server: No
8938
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008939crl-file <crlfile>
8940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8941 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8942 to verify server's certificate.
8943
8944 Supported in default-server: No
8945
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008946crt <cert>
8947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8948 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8949 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8950 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8951 certificate request.
8952
8953 Supported in default-server: No
8954
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008955disabled
8956 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8957 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8958 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8959 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8960 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8961
8962 Supported in default-server: No
8963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008964error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008965 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8966 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8967 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008969 Supported in default-server: Yes
8970
8971 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008973fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008974 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8975 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8976 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008978 Supported in default-server: Yes
8979
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008980force-sslv3
8981 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8982 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008983 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8984 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008985
8986 Supported in default-server: No
8987
8988force-tlsv10
8989 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008990 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8991 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008992
8993 Supported in default-server: No
8994
8995force-tlsv11
8996 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008997 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8998 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008999
9000 Supported in default-server: No
9001
9002force-tlsv12
9003 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009004 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9005 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009006
9007 Supported in default-server: No
9008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009010 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9011 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9012 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009014 Supported in default-server: No
9015
9016inter <delay>
9017fastinter <delay>
9018downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009019 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9020 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9021 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9022 between checks depending on the server state :
9023
9024 Server state | Interval used
9025 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9026 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9027 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9028 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9029 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9030 or yet unchecked. |
9031 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9032 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9033 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009035 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9036 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9037 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9038 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009039 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9040 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9041 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9042 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9043 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009045 Supported in default-server: Yes
9046
9047maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009048 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9049 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9050 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9051 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9052 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9053 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9054 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9055 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009057 Supported in default-server: Yes
9058
9059maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009060 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9061 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9062 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9063 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9064 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9065 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9066 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009068 Supported in default-server: Yes
9069
9070minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009071 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9072 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9073 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9074 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9075 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9076 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009077 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009080 Supported in default-server: Yes
9081
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009082no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009083 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9084 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009085 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009086
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009087 Supported in default-server: No
9088
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009089no-tls-tickets
9090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9091 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9092 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009093 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9094 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009095
9096 Supported in default-server: No
9097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009098no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009099 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009100 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9101 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009102 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9103 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9104 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009105
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009106 Supported in default-server: No
9107
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009108no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009109 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009110 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9111 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009112 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9113 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9114 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009115
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009116 Supported in default-server: No
9117
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009118no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009119 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009120 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9121 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009122 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9123 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9124 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009125
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009126 Supported in default-server: No
9127
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009128non-stick
9129 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9130 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9131 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9132
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009133 Supported in default-server: No
9134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009135observe <mode>
9136 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9137 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9138 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9139 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9140 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9141 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009142 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009144 Supported in default-server: No
9145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009146 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009148on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009149 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9150 Currently, four modes are available:
9151 - fastinter: force fastinter
9152 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9153 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9154 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9155 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009157 Supported in default-server: Yes
9158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009159 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9160
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009161on-marked-down <action>
9162 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9163 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009164 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9165 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9166 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9167 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9168 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9169 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9170 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9171 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009172
9173 Actions are disabled by default
9174
9175 Supported in default-server: Yes
9176
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009177on-marked-up <action>
9178 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9179 Currently one action is available:
9180 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9181 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9182 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9183 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9184 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9185 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9186 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9187 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9188
9189 Actions are disabled by default
9190
9191 Supported in default-server: Yes
9192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009193port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9195 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9196 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9197 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9198 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9199 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009201 Supported in default-server: Yes
9202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009203redir <prefix>
9204 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9205 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9206 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9207 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9208 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9209 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9210 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9211 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009212 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009213 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9214 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9215 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9216 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9217 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9218
9219 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009221 Supported in default-server: No
9222
9223rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9225 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9226 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009228 Supported in default-server: Yes
9229
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009230send-proxy
9231 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9232 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9233 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9234 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9235 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9236 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9237 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9238 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9239 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009240 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9241 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9242 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9243 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9244 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009245
9246 Supported in default-server: No
9247
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009248send-proxy-v2
9249 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9250 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9251 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9252 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9253 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9254 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9255 option of the "bind" keyword.
9256
9257 Supported in default-server: No
9258
9259send-proxy-v2-ssl
9260 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9261 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9262 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9263 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9264 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9265 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9266 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9267 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9268
9269 Supported in default-server: No
9270
9271send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9272 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9273 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9274 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9275 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9276 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9277 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9278 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9279 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9280 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9281
9282 Supported in default-server: No
9283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009284slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009285 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9286 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9287 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9288 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9289 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9290 parameters :
9291
9292 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9293 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9294
9295 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9296 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9297 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9298 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9299
9300 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9301 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9302 seen as failed.
9303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009304 Supported in default-server: Yes
9305
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009306source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009307source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009308source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009309 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9310 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9311 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9312 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9313
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009314 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9315 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9316 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9317 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9318 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9319 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9320 server.
9321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009322 Supported in default-server: No
9323
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009324ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009325 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9326 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9327 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9328 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9329 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9330 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009331 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009332
9333 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009335track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009336 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9337 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9338 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9339 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009340 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009342 Supported in default-server: No
9343
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009344verify [none|required]
9345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009346 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9347 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9348 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9349 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009350 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9351 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9352 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009353
9354 Supported in default-server: No
9355
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009356verifyhost <hostname>
9357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9358 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9359 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9360 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9361 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9362 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9363
9364 Supported in default-server: No
9365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009366weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009367 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9368 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9369 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009370 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9371 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9372 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9373 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9374 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9375 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009377 Supported in default-server: Yes
9378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009379
93806. HTTP header manipulation
9381---------------------------
9382
9383In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9384response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9385request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9386which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009387against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009388
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009389If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9390to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9391but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9392HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9393stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9394because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9395a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9396still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009398This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9399in section 4.2 :
9400
9401 - reqadd <string>
9402 - reqallow <search>
9403 - reqiallow <search>
9404 - reqdel <search>
9405 - reqidel <search>
9406 - reqdeny <search>
9407 - reqideny <search>
9408 - reqpass <search>
9409 - reqipass <search>
9410 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9411 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9412 - reqtarpit <search>
9413 - reqitarpit <search>
9414 - rspadd <string>
9415 - rspdel <search>
9416 - rspidel <search>
9417 - rspdeny <search>
9418 - rspideny <search>
9419 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9420 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9421
9422With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9423is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9424parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9425prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9426Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9427
9428 \t for a tab
9429 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9430 \n for a new line (LF)
9431 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9432 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9433 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9434 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9435 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9436
9437The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9438portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9439above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9440regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94419 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9442is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9443
9444The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9445after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9446
9447Notes related to these keywords :
9448---------------------------------
9449 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9450 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9451 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9452
9453 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9454 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9455 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9456
9457 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9458 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9459 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9460 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9461 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9462
9463 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9464 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9465 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9466 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9467 useless headers before adding new ones.
9468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009469 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009470 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9471
9472 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9473 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9474 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9475
9476 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9477 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009478 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009479
9480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094817. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9482----------------------------------
9483
9484Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9485client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9486The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9487these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9488but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9489data called patterns.
9490
9491
94927.1. ACL basics
9493---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009494
9495The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9496content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9497from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9498simple :
9499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009501 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009502 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9503 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009505The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9506adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009507
9508In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009510 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009511
9512This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9513Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9514and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009515an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9516conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9517as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9518are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009519
9520ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9521'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9522which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9523
9524There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9525performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009527The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9528specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9529this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009530methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9531ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009532
9533Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9534 - boolean
9535 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9536 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9537 - string
9538 - data block
9539
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009540Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9541converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9542would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9543The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9544which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9545
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009546Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9547keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9548fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9549which are summarized in the table below :
9550
9551 +---------------------+-----------------+
9552 | Sample or converter | Default |
9553 | output type | matching method |
9554 +---------------------+-----------------+
9555 | boolean | bool |
9556 +---------------------+-----------------+
9557 | integer | int |
9558 +---------------------+-----------------+
9559 | ip | ip |
9560 +---------------------+-----------------+
9561 | string | str |
9562 +---------------------+-----------------+
9563 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9564 +---------------------+-----------------+
9565
9566Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9567matching method, see below.
9568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009569The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9570 - boolean
9571 - integer or integer range
9572 - IP address / network
9573 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9574 - regular expression
9575 - hex block
9576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009577The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9578
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009579 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9580 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009581 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009582 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009583 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009584 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009585 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9588read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9589if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9590lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9591will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9592beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9593a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9594lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9595exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9596
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009597The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9598parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9599ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9600a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9601check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9602
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009603The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9604socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9605file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009607Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9608loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9609
9610 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9611
9612In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9613the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9614case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9615as well.
9616
9617The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9618sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9619do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9620methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9621is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9622obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9623followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9624default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9625that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9626string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9627
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009628The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9629By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9630string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9631resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9632server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9633waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9634flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9635function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9638sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9639be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009640
9641 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9642 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9644 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9645 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9646 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009647
9648 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9649 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009650 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009651
9652 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009653 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009654
9655 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009656 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009657
9658 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9659 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9660
9661 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9662 binary or string samples.
9663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9665 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009667 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9668 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9669 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9672 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9675 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009677 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9678 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009680 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9681 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009682 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009684 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9685 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9686 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009687
9688For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9689request, it is possible to do :
9690
9691 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9692
9693In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9694buffer, one would use the following acl :
9695
9696 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9697
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009698On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9699possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9700
9701 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9704criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9705method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9706to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9707criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9708the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009710If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009711the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9712For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9715 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9716 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9717 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009718
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009719
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009720The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9721types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9722combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9723brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9724default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009726 +-------------------------------------------------+
9727 | Input sample type |
9728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009729 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9731 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009733 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009735 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009737 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009739 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009740 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009741 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009742 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009743 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009744 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009745 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009746 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009747 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009749 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009750 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009751 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009752 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009753 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9755 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9756 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009757
9758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097597.1.1. Matching booleans
9760------------------------
9761
9762In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9763Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9764When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9765that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9766
9767Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9768return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9769"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097727.1.2. Matching integers
9773------------------------
9774
9775Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9776enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9777to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9778
9779Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9780matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9781lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009782
9783For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9784unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9785representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9786
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009787As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9788two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9789instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9790ranges and operators.
9791
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009792For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009793operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9794Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9795of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009797Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009798
9799 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9800 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9801 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9802 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9803 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009805For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009806
9807 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9808
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009809This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9810
9811 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9812
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098147.1.3. Matching strings
9815-----------------------
9816
9817String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9818different forms :
9819
9820 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9821 patterns ;
9822
9823 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9824 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9825
9826 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9827 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9828
9829 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9830 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9831
9832 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9833 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9834 matches.
9835
9836 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9837 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9838 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009839
9840String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9841exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9842characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9843string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9844to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009845before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009846
9847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098487.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9849---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009850
9851Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9852they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9853possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9854passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9855the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009856the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9857match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009858
9859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098607.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9861-------------------------------------
9862
9863It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9864not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9865a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9866to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9867digits may be used upper or lower case.
9868
9869Example :
9870 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9871 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9872
9873
98747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9875---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009876
9877IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9878netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9879within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009880host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009881difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9882at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9883does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9884parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009885
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009886IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9887Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9888trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9889IPv6 patterns.
9890
9891HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9892following situations :
9893 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9894 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9895 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9896 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9897 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9898 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9899 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9900 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9901 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9902 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009904
99057.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9906----------------------------------
9907
9908Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9909combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9910
9911 - AND (implicit)
9912 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9913 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009915A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009917 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009919Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9920indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009922For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9923"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9924requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9925is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9926
9927 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9928 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9929 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9930 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9931
9932To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9933and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9934
9935 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9936 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9937 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9938 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9939
9940 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9941 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9942 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9943 use_backend www if host_www
9944
9945It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9946expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9947be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9948the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9949
9950 The following rule :
9951
9952 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9953 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9954
9955 Can also be written that way :
9956
9957 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9958
9959It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9960to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9961simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9962sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9963good use is the following :
9964
9965 With named ACLs :
9966
9967 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9968 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9969 monitor fail if site_dead
9970
9971 With anonymous ACLs :
9972
9973 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9974
9975See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9976
9977
99787.3. Fetching samples
9979---------------------
9980
9981Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9982against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9983sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9984ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9985of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9986available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9987
9988This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9989Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9990compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9991deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9992
9993The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9994matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9995method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9996indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9997
9998As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9999when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10000mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10001the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10002ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10003
10004Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10005multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10006when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10007incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10008are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10009is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10010all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10011
10012Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10013 - name
10014 - name(arg1)
10015 - name(arg1,arg2)
10016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010017
100187.3.1. Converters
10019-----------------
10020
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010021Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10022of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10023is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10024was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10025has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10026unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10027
10028These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10029sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10030the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10031support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010033The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010034
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010035base64
10036 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10037 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10038 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10039
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010040bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10041 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10042 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10043 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10044
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010045djb2([<avalanche>])
10046 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10047 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10048 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10049 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10050 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10051 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10052 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10053 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10054 directive.
10055
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010056field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10057 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10058 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10059 list of chars.
10060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010061hex
10062 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10063 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10064 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10065 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010066
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010067http_date([<offset>])
10068 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10069 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10070 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10071 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10072 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10073 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010075in_table(<table>)
10076 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10077 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10078 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10079 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10080 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10081
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010082ipmask(<mask>)
10083 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10084 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10085 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10086 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10087
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010088json([<input-code>])
10089 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10090 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10091 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10092 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10093 of errors:
10094 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10095 bytes, ...)
10096 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10097 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10098
10099 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10100 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10101 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10102 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10103 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10104 are :
10105 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10106 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10107 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10108 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10109 error ;
10110 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10111 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10112
10113 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10114 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10115
10116 Example:
10117 capture request header user-agent len 150
10118 capture request header Host len 15
10119 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10120
10121 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10122 GET / HTTP/1.0
10123 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10124
10125 Output log:
10126 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10127
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010128language(<value>[,<default>])
10129 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10130 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10131 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10132 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10133 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10134 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10135 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10136 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10137 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10138 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10139 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10140 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010142 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010143
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010144 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10145 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010147 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10148 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10149 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10150 use_backend spanish if es
10151 use_backend french if fr
10152 use_backend english if en
10153 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010154
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010155lower
10156 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10157 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10158 type. The result is of type string.
10159
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010160ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10161 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10162 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10163 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10164 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10165 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10166 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10167
10168 Example :
10169
10170 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10171 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10172 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010174map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10175map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10176map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10177 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10178 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10179 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10180 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10181 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10182 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10183 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10184 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010185
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010186 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10187 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10188 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010189
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010190 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10191 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010192
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010193 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10194 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10195 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10196 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010197 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10198 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010199 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10200 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10201 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10203 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10204 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10205 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10207 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10209 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10211 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010214 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10215 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10216 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10217 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10218 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010219
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010220 Example :
10221
10222 # this is a comment and is ignored
10223 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10224 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10225 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10226 | | | `---------- value
10227 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10228 | `---------------------------- key
10229 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10230
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010231sdbm([<avalanche>])
10232 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10233 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10234 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10235 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10236 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10237 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10238 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10239 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10240 directive.
10241
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010242table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10243 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10244 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10245 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10246 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10247 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10248 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10249
10250
10251table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10252 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10253 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10254 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10255 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10256 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10257 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10258
10259table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10260 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10261 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10262 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10263 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10264 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10265
10266table_conn_cur(<table>)
10267 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10268 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10269 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10270 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10271 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10272
10273table_conn_rate(<table>)
10274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10276 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10277 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10278 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10279
10280table_gpc0(<table>)
10281 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10282 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10283 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10284 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10285 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10286
10287table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10288 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10289 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10290 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10291 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10292 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10293 sample fetch keyword.
10294
10295table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10296 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10297 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10298 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10299 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10300 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10301
10302table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10303 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10304 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10305 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10306 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10307 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10308 keyword.
10309
10310table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10311 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10312 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10313 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10314 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10315 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10316
10317table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10318 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10319 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10320 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10321 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10322 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10323 keyword.
10324
10325table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10328 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10329 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10330 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10331 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10332 keyword.
10333
10334table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10335 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10336 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10337 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10338 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10339 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10340 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10341 keyword.
10342
10343table_server_id(<table>)
10344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10346 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10347 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10348 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10349 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10350
10351table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10352 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10353 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10354 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10355 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10356 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10357 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10358 keyword.
10359
10360table_sess_rate(<table>)
10361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10364 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10365 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10366 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10367 keyword.
10368
10369table_trackers(<table>)
10370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10373 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10374 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10375 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10376 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10377 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10378 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10379 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10380
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010381upper
10382 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10383 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10384 type. The result is of type string.
10385
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010386utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10387 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10388 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10389 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10390 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10391 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10392 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10393
10394 Example :
10395
10396 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10397 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10398 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10399
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010400word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10401 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10402 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10403
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010404wt6([<avalanche>])
10405 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10406 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10407 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10408 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10409 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10410 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10411 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10412 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10413 directive.
10414
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104167.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010417--------------------------------------------
10418
10419A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10420not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10421"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10422The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10423
10424always_false : boolean
10425 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10426 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10427
10428always_true : boolean
10429 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10430 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10431
10432avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010433 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010434 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10435 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10436 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10437 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10438 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10439 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10440 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10441 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10442 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10443 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10444 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10445 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10446 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010448be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010449 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10450 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10451 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10452 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10453 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10456 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10457 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10458 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10459 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10460 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10461 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010462
10463 Example :
10464 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10465 backend dynamic
10466 mode http
10467 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10468 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10471 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010472 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010473 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10474 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010475
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010476 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010477 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010478 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10479
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010480 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10481 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010482
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010483 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010484 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010485 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010486 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10487 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010488 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010489 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010490
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010491 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10492 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010493 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010494 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010495
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010496date([<offset>]) : integer
10497 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10498 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10499 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10500 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010501 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10502
10503 Example :
10504
10505 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10506 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010507
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010508env(<name>) : string
10509 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10510 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10511 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10512 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10513 certain way.
10514
10515 Examples :
10516 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10517 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10518
10519 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10520 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10523 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010524 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10525 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10527 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10528 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10529 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10530 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10534 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10535 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10536 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10537 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10538 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10539 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10540 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010541
10542 Example :
10543 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10544 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10545 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10546 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10547 frontend mail
10548 bind :25
10549 mode tcp
10550 maxconn 100
10551 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10552 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10553 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10554 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010555
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010556nbproc : integer
10557 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10558 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10559 and debugging purposes.
10560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010561nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10562 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10563 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10564 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010565 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10566 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10567 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010568
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010569proc : integer
10570 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10571 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10572 debugging purposes.
10573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010575 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10576 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10577 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10579 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10580 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10581 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10582 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10583
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010584rand([<range>]) : integer
10585 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10586 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10587 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10588 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10589 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10593 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10594 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10595 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10596 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10597 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10598 methods.
10599
10600srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10601 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10602 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10603 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10604 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10605 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10606 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10607 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10608
10609srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10610 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10611 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010612 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10614 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10615 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10616 overloading servers).
10617
10618 Example :
10619 # Redirect to a separate back
10620 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10621 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10622 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10623
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010624stopping : boolean
10625 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10626 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10627 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10630 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10632
10633table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10634 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10636 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10637
10638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106397.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640----------------------------------
10641
10642The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10643closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10644methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10645sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10646TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010647the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10648counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10649"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010650argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10651the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10652this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653
10654be_id : integer
10655 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10656 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10657
10658dst : ip
10659 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10660 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10661 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10662 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10663 RFC 4291.
10664
10665dst_conn : integer
10666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10667 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10668 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10669 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10670 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10671 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10672 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10673 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675dst_port : integer
10676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10677 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10678 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10679 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10680 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10681 an HTTP header.
10682
10683fe_id : integer
10684 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10685 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10686 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010688sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010689sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10690sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10691sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010692 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10693 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10694 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010696sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010697sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10698sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10699sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010700 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10701 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10702 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010704sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010705sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10706sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10707sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010708 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10709 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010710 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10711 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10712 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010713
10714 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10715 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010716 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10717 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10718 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010719 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10720 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010722sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010723sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10724sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10725sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010726 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10727 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010729sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010730sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10731sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10732sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010733 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10734 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10735 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010737sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010738sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10739sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10740sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010741 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10742 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10743 See also src_conn_rate.
10744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010745sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010746sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10747sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10748sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010749 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010750 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010752sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010753sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10754sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10755sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010756 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10757 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10758 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010759 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10760 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10761 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010762
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010763sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010764sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10765sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10766sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010767 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10768 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10769 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10770
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010771sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010772sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10773sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10774sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010775 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10776 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10777 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10778 src_http_err_rate.
10779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010780sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010781sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10782sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10783sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010784 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10785 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10786 src_http_req_cnt.
10787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010788sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010789sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10790sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10791sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010792 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10793 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10794 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10795 src_http_req_rate.
10796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010797sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010798sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10799sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10800sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010801 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010802 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10803 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10804 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10805 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010806
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010807 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10808 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010809 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010811sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010812sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10813sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10814sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010815 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10816 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10817 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010819sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010820sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10821sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10822sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010823 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10824 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10825 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010827sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010828sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10829sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10830sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010831 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10832 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10833 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10834 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010835 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010836 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10837
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010838sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010839sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10840sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10841sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010842 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10843 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10844 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10845 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10846 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010847 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010849sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010850sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10851sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10852sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010853 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10854 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10855 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010857sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010858sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10859sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10860sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010861 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10862 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010863 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010864 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10865 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010866 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10867 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10868 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870so_id : integer
10871 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10872 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10873 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010875src : ip
10876 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10877 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10878 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10879 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10880 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10881 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10882 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010883
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010884 Example:
10885 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10886 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10889 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10890 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10891 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010892 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10895 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10896 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010897 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010898 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10901 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10902 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10903 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10904 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10905 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10906 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010907
10908 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10909 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10910 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10911 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010912 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010913 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10914 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010916src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010917 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010918 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010919 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010920 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010923 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010924 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10925 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010926 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10929 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10930 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10931 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010932 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010935 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010936 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010937 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010938 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010941 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010943 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10944 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010945 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10946 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10947 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10950 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10951 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010952 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010953 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010954 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010956src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10957 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10958 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10959 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10960 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010961 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010963src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10964 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10965 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10966 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010967 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10970 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10971 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10972 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010973 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010974 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010976src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10977 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10978 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10979 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010980 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10982 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010983
10984 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010985 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010986 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010989 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10990 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10991 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10992 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10993 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010995src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010996 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10997 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10998 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10999 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11000 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002src_port : integer
11003 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11004 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11005 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11006 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011008src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11009 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011010 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11011 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11012 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011013 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11016 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11017 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11018 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11019 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011020 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11023 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11024 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11025 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11026 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11027 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11028 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11029 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11030 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011031
11032 Example :
11033 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11034 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11035 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11036 listen ssh
11037 bind :22
11038 mode tcp
11039 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011040 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011042 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044srv_id : integer
11045 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11046 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11047 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011048
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011049
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110507.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011053The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11054closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11055when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11056usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011057future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011058
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011059ssl_bc : boolean
11060 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11061 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11062 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11063
11064ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11065 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11066 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11067
11068ssl_bc_cipher : string
11069 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11070 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11071
11072ssl_bc_protocol : string
11073 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11074 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11075
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011076ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011077 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011078 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11079 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011080
11081ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11082 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11083 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11084 if session was reused or not.
11085
11086ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11087 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11088 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11091 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11092 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11093 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11094 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11095 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11098 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11099 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11100 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11101 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011102
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011103ssl_c_der : binary
11104 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11105 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11106 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108ssl_c_err : integer
11109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11110 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11111 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11112 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11113 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11116 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11117 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11118 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11119 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11120 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11121 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11122 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11123 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125ssl_c_key_alg : string
11126 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11127 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11128 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130ssl_c_notafter : string
11131 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11132 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11133 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011135ssl_c_notbefore : string
11136 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11137 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11138 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011140ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11141 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11142 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11143 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11144 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11145 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11146 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11147 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11148 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011150ssl_c_serial : binary
11151 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11152 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11153 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11156 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11157 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11158 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011159 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11160 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11161
11162 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011164ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11165 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11166 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11167 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011169ssl_c_used : boolean
11170 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11171 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011173ssl_c_verify : integer
11174 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11175 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11176 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11177 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179ssl_c_version : integer
11180 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11181 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011182
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011183ssl_f_der : binary
11184 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11185 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11186 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11189 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11190 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11191 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11192 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011193 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011194 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11195 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11196 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198ssl_f_key_alg : string
11199 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11200 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11201 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203ssl_f_notafter : string
11204 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11205 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11206 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011208ssl_f_notbefore : string
11209 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11210 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11211 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011213ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11214 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11215 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11216 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11217 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11218 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11219 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11220 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11221 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223ssl_f_serial : binary
11224 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11225 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11226 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011227
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011228ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11229 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11230 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11231 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11234 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11235 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11236 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011238ssl_f_version : integer
11239 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11240 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11241
11242ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011243 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11244 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11245 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247 Example :
11248 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11249 listen http-https
11250 bind :80
11251 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11252 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11253
11254ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11255 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11256 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11257
11258ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011259 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011260 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11261 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11262 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11263 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11264 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11265 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11266 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11267 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269ssl_fc_cipher : string
11270 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11271 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011274 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11275 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011276 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11277 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11278 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11279 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011281ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11282 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011283 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11284 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11285 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11286 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011289 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11291 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11292 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11293 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11294 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11295 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11296 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011298ssl_fc_protocol : string
11299 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11300 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011301
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011302ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011303 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011304 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11305 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011307ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11308 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11309 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11310 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11311 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011313ssl_fc_sni : string
11314 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11315 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11316 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11317 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11318 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11319
11320 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11321 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11322 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011323 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11324 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011327 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11328 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11331 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11332 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011333
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113357.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011338Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11339sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11340only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11341For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11342be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11343can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11344sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11345for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11346content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011348payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11349 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11350 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11351 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011353payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11354 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11355 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11356 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358req.len : integer
11359req_len : integer (deprecated)
11360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11361 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11362 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11363 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11364 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11365 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11366 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11367 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11370 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011371 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11372 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11373 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11374 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376 ACL alternatives :
11377 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11380 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11381 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11382 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11383 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011385 ACL alternatives :
11386 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011390req.proto_http : boolean
11391req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11392 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11393 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11394 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11395 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11396 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11397 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11398 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011400 Example:
11401 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11402 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11403 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011404 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011406req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11407rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11408 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11409 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11410 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11411 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11412 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11413 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11414 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11417 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11418 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11419 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11420 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11421 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423 ACL derivatives :
11424 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 Example :
11427 listen tse-farm
11428 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11429 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11430 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11431 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11432 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11433 persist rdp-cookie
11434 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11435 # This is only useful makes sense if
11436 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11437 stick-table type string size 204800
11438 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11439 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11440 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11443 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11446rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11447 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11448 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11449 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11450 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011452 ACL derivatives :
11453 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011455req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11456req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11457 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11458 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11459 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11460 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11461 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11462 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11463 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465req.ssl_sni : string
11466req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11467 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11468 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11469 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11470 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11471 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11472 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11473 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11474 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11475 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11476 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11477 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11478 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480 ACL derivatives :
11481 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011483 Examples :
11484 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11485 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11486 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11487 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11488 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011490res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11491rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11492 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11493 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11494 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11495 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11496 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11497 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11498 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500req.ssl_ver : integer
11501req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11502 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11503 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11504 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11505 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11506 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11507 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11508 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11509 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11510 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512 ACL derivatives :
11513 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011514
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011515res.len : integer
11516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11517 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11518 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11519 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11520 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11521 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11522 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11523 content inspection.
11524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11526 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011527 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11528 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11529 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11530 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11533 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11534 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11535 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11536 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011540wait_end : boolean
11541 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11542 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11543 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11544 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11545 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11546 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11547 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11548 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550 Examples :
11551 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11552 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11553 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11556 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11557 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11558 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11559 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11560 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11561 tcp-request content reject
11562
11563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115647.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565--------------------------------------
11566
11567It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11568This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11569data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11570its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11571HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11572content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11573to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11574more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11575response are indexed.
11576
11577base : string
11578 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11579 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11580 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11581 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11582 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11583 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11584 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11585 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11586
11587 ACL derivatives :
11588 base : exact string match
11589 base_beg : prefix match
11590 base_dir : subdir match
11591 base_dom : domain match
11592 base_end : suffix match
11593 base_len : length match
11594 base_reg : regex match
11595 base_sub : substring match
11596
11597base32 : integer
11598 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11599 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11600 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011601 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11602 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11603 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604
11605base32+src : binary
11606 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11607 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11608 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11609 per-URL counters.
11610
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011611capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11612 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11613 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11614 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11615
11616capture.req.method : string
11617 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11618 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11619 because it's allocated.
11620
11621capture.req.uri : string
11622 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11623 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11624 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11625 allocated.
11626
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011627capture.req.ver : string
11628 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11629 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11630 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11631
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011632capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11633 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11634 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11635 The first entry is an index of 0.
11636 See also: "capture response header"
11637
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011638capture.res.ver : string
11639 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11640 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11641 persistent flag.
11642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643req.cook([<name>]) : string
11644cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11645 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11646 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11647 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11648 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11649 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11650 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11651 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11652 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11653
11654 ACL derivatives :
11655 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11656 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11657 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11658 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11659 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11660 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11661 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11662 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11665cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11666 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11667 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011669req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11670cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11671 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11672 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11673 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11674 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011676cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11677 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11678 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11679 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11680 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11681 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11682 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11683 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11684 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11685 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11686 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11689 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11690 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11691 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11692 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011693 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011695req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11696 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11697 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11698 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11699 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11700 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11701 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11702 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11703 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011705req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11706 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11707 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11708 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11709 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11712 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11713 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11714 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11715 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11716 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11717 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11718 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11719 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11720 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11721 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11722 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724 ACL derivatives :
11725 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11726 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11727 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11728 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11729 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11730 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11731 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11732 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11733
11734req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11735hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11736 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11737 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11738 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11739 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11740 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11741 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11742 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11743 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11744 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11745
11746req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11747hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11748 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11749 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11750 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11751 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11752 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11753 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11754 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11755 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11756
11757req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11758hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11759 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11760 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11761 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11762 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11763 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11764 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11765 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11766
11767http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11768 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11769 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11770 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11771 basic auth is supported.
11772
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011773http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11774 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11775 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11776 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11777 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011778 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11779 basic auth is supported.
11780
11781 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011782 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11783 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11784 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11785 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786
11787http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011788 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11789 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011790 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11791 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011793method : integer + string
11794 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11795 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11796 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11797 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11798 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11799 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11800 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802 ACL derivatives :
11803 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011805 Example :
11806 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11807 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11808 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810path : string
11811 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11812 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11813 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11814 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11815 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11816 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11817 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011819 ACL derivatives :
11820 path : exact string match
11821 path_beg : prefix match
11822 path_dir : subdir match
11823 path_dom : domain match
11824 path_end : suffix match
11825 path_len : length match
11826 path_reg : regex match
11827 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011829req.ver : string
11830req_ver : string (deprecated)
11831 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11832 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11833 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835 ACL derivatives :
11836 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838res.comp : boolean
11839 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11840 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11841 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843res.comp_algo : string
11844 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11845 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11846 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848res.cook([<name>]) : string
11849scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11850 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11851 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11852 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011854 ACL derivatives :
11855 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011857res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11858scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11859 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11860 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11861 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011863res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11864scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11865 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11866 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11867 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011869res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11871 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11872 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11873 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11874 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11875 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11876 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11877 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11878 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011880res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11881 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11882 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11883 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11884 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11885 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11888shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11889 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11890 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11891 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11892 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11893 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11894 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11895 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11896 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898 ACL derivatives :
11899 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11900 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11901 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11902 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11903 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11904 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11905 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11906 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11907
11908res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11909shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11910 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11911 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11912 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11913 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11914 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011916res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11917shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11918 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11919 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11920 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11921 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11922 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11923 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011925res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11926shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11927 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11928 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11929 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11930 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11931 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11932 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934res.ver : string
11935resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11936 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11937 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011939 ACL derivatives :
11940 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11943 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11944 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11945 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11946 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011948 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11949 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011951 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011953status : integer
11954 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11955 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11956 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958url : string
11959 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11960 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11961 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11962 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11963 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11964 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11965 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967 ACL derivatives :
11968 url : exact string match
11969 url_beg : prefix match
11970 url_dir : subdir match
11971 url_dom : domain match
11972 url_end : suffix match
11973 url_len : length match
11974 url_reg : regex match
11975 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977url_ip : ip
11978 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11979 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11980 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11981 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11982 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11983 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11984 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011986url_port : integer
11987 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11988 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11989 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11990 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11993url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11994 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11995 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11996 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11997 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11998 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11999 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12000 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12001 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12002 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012004 ACL derivatives :
12005 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12006 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12007 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12008 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12009 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12010 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12011 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12012 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012013
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015 Example :
12016 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12017 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12018 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12019 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12022 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12023 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12024 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012025
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120277.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012028---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012030Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12031every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012032order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012034ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12035---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012036FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012037HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012038HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12039HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012040HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12041HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12042HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12043HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12044LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012045METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12046METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12047METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12048METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12049METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12050METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012051RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012052REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012053TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012054WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12055---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012056
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120588. Logging
12059----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012060
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012061One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12062provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12063very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12064provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12065state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012066to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012067headers.
12068
12069In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12070about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12071send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12072
12073 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12074 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12075 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12076 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12077 at the termination.
12078
12079The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12080allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12081as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12082while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12083real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12084delay.
12085
12086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120878.1. Log levels
12088---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012089
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012090TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012091source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012092HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12093in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12094track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12095syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12096about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012097
12098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120998.2. Log formats
12100----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012101
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012102HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012103and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12104slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12105options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012106
12107 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12108 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12109 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12110 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12111 extents.
12112
12113 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12114 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12115 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12116 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12117 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12118
12119 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12120 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12121 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12122 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12123 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12124
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012125 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12126 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12127 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12128 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12129
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012130 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012132Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12133specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12134field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12135servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12136always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12137identifier.
12138
12139Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12140 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12141 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12142 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12143 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12144
12145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121468.2.1. Default log format
12147-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012148
12149This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12150as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12151format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12152
12153 Example :
12154 listen www
12155 mode http
12156 log global
12157 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12158
12159 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12160 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12161 (www/HTTP)
12162
12163 Field Format Extract from the example above
12164 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12165 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12166 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12167 4 'to' to
12168 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12169 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12170
12171Detailed fields description :
12172 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12173 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12174 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12175 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12176 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12177 and processed the connection.
12178 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12179
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012180In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12181"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12182connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012184It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12185will eventually disappear.
12186
12187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121888.2.2. TCP log format
12189---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012190
12191The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12192is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12193information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12194counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12195emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12196environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12197the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12198sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012199specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12200not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12201fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12202marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012203
12204 Example :
12205 frontend fnt
12206 mode tcp
12207 option tcplog
12208 log global
12209 default_backend bck
12210
12211 backend bck
12212 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12213
12214 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12215 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12216 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12217
12218 Field Format Extract from the example above
12219 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12220 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12221 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12222 4 frontend_name fnt
12223 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12224 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12225 7 bytes_read* 212
12226 8 termination_state --
12227 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12228 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12229
12230Detailed fields description :
12231 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012232 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12233 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12234 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12235 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12236 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012237
12238 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012239 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12240 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12241 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012242
12243 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12244 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12245 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12246 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12247
12248 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12249 and processed the connection.
12250
12251 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12252 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12253 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12254 applications.
12255
12256 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12257 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12258 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12259 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12260 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12261
12262 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12263 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12264 See "Timers" below for more details.
12265
12266 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12267 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12268 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12269 "Timers" below for more details.
12270
12271 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012272 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012273 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12274 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12275 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12276 details.
12277
12278 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12279 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12280 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12281 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12282 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12283
12284 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12285 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12286 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12287 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12288 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12289 for more details.
12290
12291 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012292 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012293 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12294 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12295 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012296 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012297
12298 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12299 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12300 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12301 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12302 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12303 caused by a denial of service attack.
12304
12305 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12306 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12307 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12308 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12309 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12310 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12311 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12312 denial of service attack.
12313
12314 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12315 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12316 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12317 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12318 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12319 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12320 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12321 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12322 be processed than on other servers.
12323
12324 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12325 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12326 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12327 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12328 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12329 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12330 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12331 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12332 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12333 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12334 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12335 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12336 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12337
12338 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12339 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12340 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12341 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12342 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12343 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12344 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12345 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12346
12347 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12348 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12349 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12350 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12351 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12352 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12353 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12354 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12355 occurs.
12356
12357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123588.2.3. HTTP log format
12359----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012360
12361The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12362is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12363the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12364are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12365emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12366generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12367"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12368which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012369frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12370is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012371
12372Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12373slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12374with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12375
12376 Example :
12377 frontend http-in
12378 mode http
12379 option httplog
12380 log global
12381 default_backend bck
12382
12383 backend static
12384 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12385
12386 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12387 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12388 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012389 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012390
12391 Field Format Extract from the example above
12392 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12393 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12394 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12395 4 frontend_name http-in
12396 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12397 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12398 7 status_code 200
12399 8 bytes_read* 2750
12400 9 captured_request_cookie -
12401 10 captured_response_cookie -
12402 11 termination_state ----
12403 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12404 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12405 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12406 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12407 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012409
12410Detailed fields description :
12411 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012412 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12413 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12414 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12415 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12416 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012417
12418 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012419 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12420 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12421 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012422
12423 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12424 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12425 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12426 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12427 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12428
12429 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12430 and processed the connection.
12431
12432 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12433 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12434 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12435
12436 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12437 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12438 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12439 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12440 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12441 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12442
12443 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12444 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12445 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12446 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12447 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12448 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12449
12450 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12451 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12452 See "Timers" below for more details.
12453
12454 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12455 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12456 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12457 below for more details.
12458
12459 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12460 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12461 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12462 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12463 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12464 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12465 for more details.
12466
12467 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012468 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012469 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12470 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12471 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12472 details.
12473
12474 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12475 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12476 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12477
12478 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12479 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12480 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12481 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12482 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12483 overflowing.
12484
12485 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12486 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12487 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12488 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12489 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12490 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12491 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12492 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12493
12494 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12495 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12496 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12497 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12498 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12499 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12500 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12501 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12502
12503 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12504 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12505 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12506 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12507 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12508 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12509 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12510
12511 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012512 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012513 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12514 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12515 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012516 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012517 system.
12518
12519 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12520 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12521 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12522 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12523 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12524 caused by a denial of service attack.
12525
12526 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12527 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12528 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12529 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12530 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12531 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12532 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12533 denial of service attack.
12534
12535 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12536 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12537 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12538 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12539 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12540 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12541 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12542 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12543 processed than on other servers.
12544
12545 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12546 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12547 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12548 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12549 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12550 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12551 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12552 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12553 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12554 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12555 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12556 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12557 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12558
12559 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12560 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12561 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12562 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12563 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12564 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12565 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12566 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12567
12568 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12569 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12570 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12571 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12572 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12573 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12574 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12575 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12576 occurs.
12577
12578 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12579 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12580 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12581 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12582 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12583 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12584 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12585 cookies" below for more details.
12586
12587 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12588 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12589 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12590 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12591 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12592 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12593 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12594 and cookies" below for more details.
12595
12596 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12597 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12598 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12599 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12600 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12601 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12602 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12603 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12604
12605
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200126068.2.4. Custom log format
12607------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012608
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012609The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012610mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012611
12612HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12613Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12614separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12615prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12616
12617Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12618variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12619string formats ("Q").
12620
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012621If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012622as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012623less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12624the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12625
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012626Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012627In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012628in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012629
12630Flags are :
12631 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012632 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012633
12634 Example:
12635
12636 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12637 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12638
12639At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12640
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012641 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12642 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012643
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012644the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012645
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012646 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012647 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012648 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012649
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012650and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12651
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012652 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012653 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12654
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012655Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12656
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012657 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012658 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012659 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12660 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12661 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012662 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12663 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12664 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012665 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012666 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012667 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012668 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012669 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012670 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012671 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12672 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012673 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012674 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12675 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012676 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012677 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12678 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012679 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12680 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12681 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012682 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012683 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12684 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012685 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012686 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12687 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12688 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012689 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012690 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012691 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12692 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12693 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12694 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012695 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012696 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012697 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012698 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012699 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012700 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012701 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12702 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12703 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012704 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012705 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12706 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012707 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012708 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012709 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012710 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012711
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012712 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012713
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012714
127158.2.5. Error log format
12716-----------------------
12717
12718When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12719protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12720By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12721"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12722will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12723logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12724
12725The format looks like this :
12726
12727 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12728 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12729 Connection error during SSL handshake
12730
12731 Field Format Extract from the example above
12732 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12733 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12734 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12735 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12736 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12737
12738These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12739failures.
12740
12741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127428.3. Advanced logging options
12743-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012744
12745Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12746just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12747options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12748for more information about their usage.
12749
12750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12752------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012753
12754It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12755haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12756commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12757monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12758ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12759
12760 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12761 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12762 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12763 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12764
12765 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12766 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12767 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012768 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012769 such as other load-balancers.
12770
12771 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12772 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12773 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12774
12775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127768.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12777----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012778
12779The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12780what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12781or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12782"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12783just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12784log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12785after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12786is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12787with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12788with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12789
12790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12792------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012793
12794Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12795for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12796"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12797retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12798raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12799a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12800file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12801you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12802"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12803
12804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12806--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012807
12808Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12809multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12810them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12811"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12812logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12813error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12814and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12815too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12816useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12817alternative.
12818
12819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128208.4. Timing events
12821------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012822
12823Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12824reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12825the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12826frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12827mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12828
12829 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12830 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12831 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12832 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12833 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12834
12835 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12836 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12837 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12838 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12839 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12840
12841 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12842 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12843 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12844 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12845 connection never established.
12846
12847 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12848 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12849 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12850 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12851 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12852 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12853 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12854 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12855 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12856 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12857 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12858
12859 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12860 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12861 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12862 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012863 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012864
12865 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12866
12867 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12868 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12869 negative.
12870
12871These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12872protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12873that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012874due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012875close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12876session has been aborted on timeout.
12877
12878Most common cases :
12879
12880 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12881 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12882 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12883 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12884 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12885 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12886 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12887 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12888 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012889 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12890 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12891 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012892
12893 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12894 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12895 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12896 of ms on remote networks.
12897
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012898 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12899 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12900 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012901
12902 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12903 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12904 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12905 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12906 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12907 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12908 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12909 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12910 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12911 to the server until another one is released.
12912
12913Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12914
12915 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12916 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12917 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12918
12919 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12920 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12921 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12922
12923 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12924 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12925 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12926 flags.
12927
12928 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12929 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12930 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12931 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12932 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12933 the client connection was maintained open.
12934
12935 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012936 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012937 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12938 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12939
12940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129418.5. Session state at disconnection
12942-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012943
12944TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12945"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
129462-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12947each of which has a special meaning :
12948
12949 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12950 session to terminate :
12951
12952 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12953
12954 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12955 server explicitly refused it.
12956
12957 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12958 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12959 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12960 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012961 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12962
12963 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12964 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012965
12966 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12967 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12968 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12969 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12970 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12971
12972 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12973 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12974 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12975 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12976 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12977
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012978 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12979 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12980
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012981 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12982 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12983 backup connections when going up.
12984
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012985 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12986
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012987 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12988 send or receive data.
12989
12990 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12991 send or receive data.
12992
12993 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12994 with nothing left in the buffers.
12995
12996 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12997
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012998 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012999 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13000
13001 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13002 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13003 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13004 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13005 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13006
13007 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13008 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13009
13010 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13011 server (HTTP only).
13012
13013 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13014
13015 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13016 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13017 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13018
13019 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13020 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13021 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13022
13023 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13024
13025 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13026 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13027
13028 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13029 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13030 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13031
13032 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13033 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013034 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13035 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013036
13037 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13038 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13039 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13040 another server.
13041
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013042 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013043 server.
13044
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013045 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13046 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13047 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13048 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13049
13050 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13051 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13052 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13053 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13054
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013055 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13056 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13057 "use-server" rule).
13058
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013059 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13060
13061 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13062 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13063
13064 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13065
13066 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13067 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13068 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13069
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013070 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13071 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013072 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013073 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13074 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13075
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013076 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13077
13078 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13079 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13080
13081 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13082
13083 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13084
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013085The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13086was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013087helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13088starvation, attacks, etc...
13089
13090The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13091alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13092easier finding and understanding.
13093
13094 Flags Reason
13095
13096 -- Normal termination.
13097
13098 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13099 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13100 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13101 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13102
13103 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13104 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13105 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13106 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13107 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13108 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013110 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13111 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013112 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113
13114 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13115 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13116 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13117
13118 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13119 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13120 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13121 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13122 the server takes too long to respond.
13123
13124 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13125 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13126 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13127 long a time to respond.
13128
13129 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13130 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13131 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13132 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13133 and the client.
13134
13135 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13136 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13137 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13138 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13139 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013140 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13141 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13142 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13143 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13144 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13145 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13146 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13147 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13148 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13149 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13150 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13151 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13152 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13153 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013154
13155 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13156 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013157 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13158 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13159 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13160 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013161
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013162 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13163 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013165 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013166 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13167 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13168 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13169 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13170 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13171
13172 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13173 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13174 503 or 504 here.
13175
13176 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13177 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13178 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13179 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13180 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13181
13182 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13183 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013184 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013185 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13186 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13187
13188 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13189 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13190 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13191 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13192 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13193 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13194 between haproxy and the server.
13195
13196 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13197 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13198 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13199 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13200 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13201 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13202 solution is to fix the application.
13203
13204 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13205 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13206 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13207 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13208 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13209 external attacks.
13210
13211 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13212 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013213 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013214 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13215 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13216
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013217 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13218 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13219 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013220 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13221 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013223 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13224 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13225 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13226 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013227 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13228 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13229 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13230 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13231 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013232
13233 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13234 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13235 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13236 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13237
13238 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13239 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13240 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13241 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13242
13243 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13244 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13245 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13246 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13247
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013248The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13249persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13250important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13251re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13252
13253 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13254
13255 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13256 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13257 set on a GET request.
13258
13259 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13260 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013261 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013262 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13263
13264 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13265 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13266 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13267
13268 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13269 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13270 already got a cookie.
13271
13272 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13273 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13274 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13275 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13276 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13277
13278 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13279 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13280 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13281
13282 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13283 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13284 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13285
13286 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13287 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13288
13289 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13290 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13291 then advertised in the response.
13292
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132948.6. Non-printable characters
13295-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013296
13297In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13298consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13299converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13300prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13301being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13302escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13303is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13304'}' when logging headers.
13305
13306Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13307issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13308containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13309
13310Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13311the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13312performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13313
13314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133158.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13316---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013317
13318Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13319achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013320section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013321cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13322the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13323the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013325not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13326user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13327a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13328wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13329
13330 Examples :
13331 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13332 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13333
13334 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13335 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13336
13337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133388.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13339---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013340
13341Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13342proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13343the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13344server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13345
13346Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13347response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013348section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013349
13350It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013351time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13352appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013353are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13354and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13355follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13356request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13357in the logs.
13358
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013359As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13360frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13361an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13362
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013363 Example :
13364 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13365 listen proxy-out
13366 mode http
13367 option httplog
13368 option logasap
13369 log global
13370 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13371
13372 # log the name of the virtual server
13373 capture request header Host len 20
13374
13375 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13376 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13377
13378 # log the beginning of the referrer
13379 capture request header Referer len 20
13380
13381 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13382 capture response header Server len 20
13383
13384 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13385 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13386
13387 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13388 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13389
13390 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13391 capture response header Via len 20
13392
13393 # log the URL location during a redirection
13394 capture response header Location len 20
13395
13396 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13397 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13398 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13399 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13400 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13401
13402 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13403 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13404 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13405 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013406 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013407
13408 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13409 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13410 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13411 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13412 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013413 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013414
13415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134168.9. Examples of logs
13417---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013418
13419These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13420them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13421reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13422
13423 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13424 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13425 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13426
13427 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13428 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13429
13430 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13431 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13432 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13433
13434 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13435 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13436
13437 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13438 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13439 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13440
13441 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013442 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013443 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13444 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13445
13446 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13447 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13448 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13449
13450 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13451 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013452 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013453 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13454 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13455 to return the 502 and not the server.
13456
13457 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013458 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013459
13460 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13461 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13462 Nothing was sent to any server.
13463
13464 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13465 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13466
13467 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13468 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13469 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13470 send a 408 return code to the client.
13471
13472 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13473 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13474
13475 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13476 5 seconds ("c----").
13477
13478 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13479 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013480 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013481
13482 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013483 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013484 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13485 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13486 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13487 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13488 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013489
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134919. Statistics and monitoring
13492----------------------------
13493
13494It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13495mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13496CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13497Unix socket.
13498
13499
135009.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013501---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013502
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013503The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013504page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13505begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13506represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13507use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13508('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13509(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13510text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13511do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13512use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013513
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013514In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13515that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13516S (Servers).
13517
13518 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13519 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13520 any name for server/listener)
13521 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13522 number queued without a server assigned.
13523 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13524 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13525 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13526 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13527 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13528 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13529 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13530 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13531 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13532 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13533 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13534 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13535 "option checkcache".
13536 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13537 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13538 - read error from the client
13539 - client timeout
13540 - client closed connection
13541 - various bad requests from the client.
13542 - request was tarpitted.
13543 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13544 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13545 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13546 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13547 active servers).
13548 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13549 Some other errors are:
13550 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13551 - failure applying filters to the response.
13552 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13553 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13554 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13555 switched away from.
13556 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13557 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13558 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13559 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13560 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13561 the server is up.)
13562 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13563 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13564 counters for each server.
13565 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13566 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13567 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13568 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13569 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13570 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13571 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13572 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13573 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13574 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13575 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13576 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13577 of times that server was selected.
13578 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13579 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13580 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13581 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13582 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13583 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013584 UNK -> unknown
13585 INI -> initializing
13586 SOCKERR -> socket error
13587 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13588 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13589 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13590 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13591 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13592 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13593 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13594 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13595 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13596 disable-on-404
13597 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13598 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13599 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013600 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13601 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13602 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13603 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13604 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13605 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13606 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13607 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13608 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13609 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13610 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13611 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13612 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13613 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13614 (inc. in eresp)
13615 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13616 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13617 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13618 (CPU/BW limit)
13619 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13620 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13621 server/backend
13622 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13623 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13624 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13625 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13626 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13627 (0 for TCP)
13628 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13629 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013630
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136329.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013633-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013634
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013635The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13636necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13637A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13638issuing commands by hand :
13639
13640 global
13641 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13642 stats timeout 2m
13643
13644It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13645the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13646never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13647situations :
13648
13649 global
13650 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13651 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13652 stats timeout 2m
13653
13654To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13655swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13656to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13657syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13658
13659 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13660 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13661
13662The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13663script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13664for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13665
13666The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13667that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13668editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13669(eg: watch a counter).
13670
13671The socket supports two operation modes :
13672 - interactive
13673 - non-interactive
13674
13675The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13676this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13677sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13678mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13679commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13680example :
13681
13682 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13683
13684The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13685entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13686for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13687sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13688"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13689after processing the last command of the same line.
13690
13691For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13692"prompt" command :
13693
13694 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13695 prompt
13696 > show info
13697 ...
13698 >
13699
13700Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13701delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13702that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13703parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013704
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013705It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13706on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13707own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013708
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013709The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13710If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13711all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13712it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13713
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013714add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013715 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13716 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13717 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13718 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013719
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013720add map <map> <key> <value>
13721 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13722 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013723 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13724 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13725 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013726
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013727clear counters
13728 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13729 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13730 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13731 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13732 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13733
13734clear counters all
13735 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13736 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13737 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13738
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013739clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013740 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13741 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13742 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013743
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013744clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013745 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13746 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13747 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013748
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013749clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13750 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13751
13752 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13753 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13754 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13755 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13756 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13757 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13758
13759 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13760
13761 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13762 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13763 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13764 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13765 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13766 the ACLs :
13767
13768 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13769 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13770 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13771 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13772 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13773 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13774
13775 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013776 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13777 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013778
13779 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013780 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013781 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013782 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13783 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13784 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13785 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013786
13787 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13788
13789 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013790 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013791 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13792 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013793 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13794 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13795 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013796
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013797del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13798 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013799 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13800 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13801 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13802 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013803
13804del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013805 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013806 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13807 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13808 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13809 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013810
13811disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013812 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13813
13814 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13815 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13816 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13817 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13818 re-enabled using enable agent.
13819
13820 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13821 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13822 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13823 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13824 otherwise unchanged.
13825
13826 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13827 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13828 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13829
13830 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13831 level "admin".
13832
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013833disable frontend <frontend>
13834 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13835 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13836 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13837 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13838 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13839 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13840 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13841 on the stats page.
13842
13843 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13844 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13845
13846 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13847 level "admin".
13848
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013849disable health <backend>/<server>
13850 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13851 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13852 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13853 agent check forces it down.
13854
13855 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13856 level "admin".
13857
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013858disable server <backend>/<server>
13859 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13860 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13861 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13862 during the maintenance.
13863
13864 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13865 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13866
13867 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013868 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013869
13870 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13871 level "admin".
13872
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013873enable agent <backend>/<server>
13874 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13875
13876 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13877 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13878
13879 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13880 level "admin".
13881
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013882enable frontend <frontend>
13883 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13884 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13885 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13886 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13887 which was disabled.
13888
13889 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13890 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13891
13892 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13893 level "admin".
13894
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013895enable health <backend>/<server>
13896 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13897 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13898
13899 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13900 level "admin".
13901
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013902enable server <backend>/<server>
13903 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13904 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13905
13906 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013907 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013908
13909 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13910 level "admin".
13911
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013912get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013913get acl <acl> <value>
13914 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13915 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13916 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13917 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13918 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013919
13920 The first two words are:
13921
13922 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13923 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13924 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13925
13926 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13927
13928 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13929
13930 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13931
13932 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13933 interpretation of the case.
13934
13935 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13936 useful with regular expressions.
13937
13938 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13939 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13940
13941 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13942 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13943 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13944
13945 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13946
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013947get weight <backend>/<server>
13948 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13949 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13950 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13951 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13952 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013953 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013954
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013955help
13956 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13957 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013958
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013959prompt
13960 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13961 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13962 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13963 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13964 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13965 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13966 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13967 command.
13968
13969quit
13970 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013971
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013972set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013973 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13974 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13975 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013976
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013977set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013978 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13979 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13980 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13981 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13982 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013983 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13984 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13985
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013986set maxconn global <maxconn>
13987 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13988 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13989 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13990 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13991 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13992 setting.
13993
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013994set rate-limit connections global <value>
13995 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13996 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13997 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13998 is passed in number of connections per second.
13999
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014000set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14001 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14002 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014003 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14004 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014005
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014006set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14007 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14008 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14009 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14010 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14011
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014012set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14013 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14014 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14015 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14016 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14017 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14018
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014019set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14020 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14021 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14022 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14023
14024set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14025 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14026 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14027 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14028
14029set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14030 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14031 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14032 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14033 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14034 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14035 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14036 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14037 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14038
14039set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14040 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14041 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14042
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014043set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14044 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14045 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14046 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14047 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14048
14049 Example:
14050 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14051 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14052 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14053 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14054
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014055set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014056 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14057 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14058 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14059 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014060 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14061 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014062
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014063set timeout cli <delay>
14064 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14065 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14066 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14067
14068set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14069 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14070 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014071 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14072 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14073 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14074 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14075 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14076 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14077 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14078 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14079 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14080 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14081 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14082 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14083 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014084
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014085show errors [<iid>]
14086 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14087 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014088 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14089 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14090 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014091
14092 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14093 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14094 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14095 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14096 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14097 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14098 are reported too.
14099
14100 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14101 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14102 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14103 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14104 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14105 code.
14106
14107 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14108 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14109 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14110 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14111 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14112 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14113 line.
14114
14115 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014116 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14117 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014118 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14119 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14120
14121 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14122 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14123 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14124 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14125 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14126 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14127 00204+ minal\r\n
14128 00211 \r\n
14129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014130 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014131 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14132 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14133 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14134 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14135 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14136 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014137
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014138show info
14139 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14140
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014141show map [<map>]
14142 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014143 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14144 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14145 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14146 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14147 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14148 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014149
14150show acl [<acl>]
14151 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014152 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14153 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14154 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14155 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14156 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014157
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014158show pools
14159 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14160 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14161 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14162 the pools.
14163
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014164show sess
14165 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014166 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14167 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14168
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014169show sess <id>
14170 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14171 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14172 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14173 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14174 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014175 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14176 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14177
14178 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14179 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014180
14181show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14182 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14183 possible to dump only selected items :
14184 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14185 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14186 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14187 for example:
14188 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14189 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14190 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14191
14192 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014193 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14194 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014195 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14196 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14197 Nbproc: 1
14198 Process_num: 1
14199 (...)
14200
14201 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14202 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14203 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14204 (...)
14205 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14206
14207 $
14208
14209 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14210 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14211 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14212 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014213 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014214
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014215show table
14216 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14217 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14218 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14219 entries currently in use.
14220
14221 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014222 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014223 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14224 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014225
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014226show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014227 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14228 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14229 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014230 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14231
14232 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14233 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14234 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14235 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14236 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14237
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014238 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14239 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14240 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14241 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14242 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14243 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14244
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014245
14246 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014247 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14248 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014249
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014250 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014251 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014252 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014253 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14254 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14255 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14256 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014257
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014258 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014259 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014260 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14261 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014262
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014263 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14264 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014265 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014266 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14267 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014268
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014269 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14270 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014271 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014272 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14273 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14274
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014275 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14276 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14277 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14278 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14279 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14280
14281 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14282 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14283 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014284 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14285 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014286 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14287 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014288
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014289shutdown frontend <frontend>
14290 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14291 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14292 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14293 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14294 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14295 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14296 once it is terminated.
14297
14298 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14299 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14300
14301 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14302 level "admin".
14303
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014304shutdown session <id>
14305 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14306 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14307 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14308 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14309 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14310 flag in the logs.
14311
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014312shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014313 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14314 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14315 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14316 'K' flag in the logs.
14317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014318/*
14319 * Local variables:
14320 * fill-column: 79
14321 * End:
14322 */